target.def (narrow_volatile_bitfield): Note that the default value is false, not...
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
36 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
37 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
38 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
39 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
40 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
41 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
53 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
54 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
55 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 @node Driver
111 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
112 @cindex driver
113 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
114
115 @c prevent bad page break with this line
116 You can control the compilation driver.
117
118 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
119 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
120 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
121
122 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
123 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
124 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
125 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
126 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
127 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
128
129 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
130 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
131 that the other specs are easier to write.
132
133 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
134 @end defmac
135
136 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
137 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
138 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
139 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
140 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
141
142 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
143 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
144 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
145 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
146 everywhere it occurs.
147
148 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
149 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
150 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
151
152 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
153 @end defmac
154
155 @defmac CPP_SPEC
156 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
157 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
158 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
164 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
165 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
166 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
167 @end defmac
168
169 @defmac CC1_SPEC
170 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
171 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
172 front ends.
173 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
174 for GCC to pass to front ends.
175
176 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177 @end defmac
178
179 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
180 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
181 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
182 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
186 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
187 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
188 @end defmac
189
190 @defmac ASM_SPEC
191 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
192 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
193 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
194 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
195
196 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
197 @end defmac
198
199 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
201 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
202 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
203 an example of this.
204
205 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
206 @end defmac
207
208 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
209 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
210 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
211 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
212 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
213 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
214
215 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
216 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
217 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
218 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
219 @end defmac
220
221 @defmac LINK_SPEC
222 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
223 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
224 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LIB_SPEC
230 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
231 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
232 command given to the linker.
233
234 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
235 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
236 @end defmac
237
238 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
239 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
240 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
241 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
242 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
243
244 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
245 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
246 @end defmac
247
248 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
249 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
250 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
251 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
252 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
253 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
254 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
255 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
256 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
257 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
258 @end defmac
259
260 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
261 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
262 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
263 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
264 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
265 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
266 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
267 @end defmac
268
269 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
270 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
271 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
272 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
273 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
274 @end defmac
275
276 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
277 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
278 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
279 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
280
281 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
282 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
283 @end defmac
284
285 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
286 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
287 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
288 the very end of the command given to the linker.
289
290 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
291 @end defmac
292
293 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
294 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
295 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
296 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
297 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
298 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
299 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
300 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
301 @end defmac
302
303 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
304 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
305 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
306 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
307 @end defmac
308
309 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
310 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
311 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
312 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
313 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
314 @end defmac
315
316 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
317 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
318 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
319 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
320
321 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
322 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
323 string constant that provides the specification.
324
325 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
326
327 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
328 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
329 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
330 these definitions.
331
332 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
333 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
334 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
335 used.
336
337 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
338
339 @smallexample
340 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
341 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
342
343 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
344 @end smallexample
345
346 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
347 @smallexample
348 #undef CPP_SPEC
349 #define CPP_SPEC \
350 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
351 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
352 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
353 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
354
355 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
356 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
357 @end smallexample
358
359 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
360 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
361
362 @smallexample
363 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
364 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
365 @end smallexample
366 @end defmac
367
368 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
369 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
370 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
371 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
372 @end defmac
373
374 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
375 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
376 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
377 @end defmac
378
379 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
380 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
381 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
382 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
383 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
384 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
385 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
386 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
387 @end defmac
388
389 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
390 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
391 @end deftypevr
392
393 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
394 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
395 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
396 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
397 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
398
399 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
400 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
402 @xref{Target Fragment}.
403 @end defmac
404
405 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
406 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
407 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
408 indicates an absolute file name.
409 @end defmac
410
411 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
412 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
413 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
414 when the compiler is built as a cross
415 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
416 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
417 @end defmac
418
419 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
420 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
421 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
422 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
423 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
424 is built as a cross compiler.
425 @end defmac
426
427 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
428 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
429 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
430 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
431 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
432 is built as a cross compiler.
433 @end defmac
434
435 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
436 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
437 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
438 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
439 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
440 is built as a cross compiler.
441 @end defmac
442
443 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
444 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
445 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
446 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
447 @end defmac
448
449 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
450 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
451 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
452 cross compiler.
453 @end defmac
454
455 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
456 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
457 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
458 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
459 initialize the necessary environment variables.
460 @end defmac
461
462 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
463 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
464 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
465 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
466 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
467 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
468
469 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
470 replacement.
471 @end defmac
472
473 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
474 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
475 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
476 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
477 @end defmac
478
479 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
480 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
481 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
482 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
483 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
484 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
485 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
486 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
488
489 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
490 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
491 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
492 for C++-only directories,
493 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
494 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
495 the array with a null element.
496
497 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
498 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
499 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
500 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
501
502 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
503
504 @smallexample
505 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
506 @{ \
507 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
508 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
511 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
512 @}
513 @end smallexample
514 @end defmac
515
516 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
517
518 @enumerate
519 @item
520 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
521
522 @item
523 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
524 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
525 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
526
527 @item
528 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
529
530 @item
531 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
532 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
533
534 @item
535 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
536
537 @item
538 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
539
540 @item
541 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
542 compiler.
543 @end enumerate
544
545 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
546
547 @enumerate
548 @item
549 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
550
551 @item
552 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
553 value based on the installed toolchain location.
554
555 @item
556 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
557 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
558
559 @item
560 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
561 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
562
563 @item
564 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
565
566 @item
567 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
568 compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
572 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
580 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
581 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
582
583 @item
584 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
585 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
586 @file{/lib/}.
587
588 @item
589 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
590 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
591 @file{/usr/lib/}.
592 @end enumerate
593
594 @node Run-time Target
595 @section Run-time Target Specification
596 @cindex run-time target specification
597 @cindex predefined macros
598 @cindex target specifications
599
600 @c prevent bad page break with this line
601 Here are run-time target specifications.
602
603 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
604 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
605 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
606 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
607 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
608 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
609 finished command line option processing your code can use those
610 results freely.
611
612 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
613 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
614 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
615 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
616
617 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
618 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
619 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
620 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
621 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
622 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
623 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
624 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
625 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
626 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
627
628 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
629 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
630 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
631 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
632 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
633 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
634 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
635 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
636 preprocessing.
637 @end defmac
638
639 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
640 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
641 and is used for the target operating system instead.
642 @end defmac
643
644 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
645 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
646 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
647 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
648 it yourself.
649 @end defmac
650
651 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
652 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
653 any target-specific headers.
654 @end deftypevar
655
656 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
657 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
658 Its default setting is 0.
659 @end deftypevr
660
661 @cindex optional hardware or system features
662 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
663
664 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
665 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
666 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
667 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
668 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
669 definition does nothing but return true.
670
671 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
672 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
673 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
674 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
675 via attributes).
676 @end deftypefn
677
678 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
679 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
680 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
681 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
682 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
683 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
684 default definition does nothing but return false.
685
686 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
687 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
688 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
689 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
690 @end deftypefn
691
692 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
693 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
697 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
705 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
713 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
714 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
715 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
716 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
717 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
718 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
719 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
720 @end deftypefn
721
722 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
723 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
724 but is only used in the C
725 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
726 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
727 frontends.
728 @end defmac
729
730 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
731 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
732 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
733 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
734 options are processed once
735 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
736 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
737 options passed explicitly.
738
739 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
740 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
741 @code{optimize} attribute.
742 @end deftypevr
743
744 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
745 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
746 @end deftypefn
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
749 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
753 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
754 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
755 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
756 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
757 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
758
759 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
760 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
761 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
762 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
763 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
764 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
765 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
766
767 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
768 is 0.
769 @end defmac
770
771 @node Per-Function Data
772 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
773 @cindex per-function data
774 @cindex data structures
775
776 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
777 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
778 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
779 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
780 when another one comes along.
781
782 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
783 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
784 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
785 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
786 to their own specific data.
787
788 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
789 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
790 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
791 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
792
793 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
794 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
795 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
796 function, for level 0.
797
798 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
799 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
800 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
801 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
802 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
803 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
804 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
805 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
806 longer supported.
807
808 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
809 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
810 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
811 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
812 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
813 @end defmac
814
815 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
816 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
817 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
818 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
819 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
820 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
821
822 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
823 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
824 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
825 @end deftypevar
826
827 @node Storage Layout
828 @section Storage Layout
829 @cindex storage layout
830
831 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
832 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
833 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
834 @xref{Run-time Target}.
835
836 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
837 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
838 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
839 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
840 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
841 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
842 macro need not be a constant.
843
844 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
845 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
846 @end defmac
847
848 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
849 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
850 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
851 @end defmac
852
853 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
854 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
855 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
856 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
857 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
858 macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
863 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
864 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
865 the order of words in memory.
866 @end defmac
867
868 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
869 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
870 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
871 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
872 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
873
874 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
875 multi-word integers.
876 @end defmac
877
878 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
879 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
880 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
881 @end defmac
882
883 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
884 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
885 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
886 @end defmac
887
888 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
889 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
890 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
891 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
892 @end defmac
893
894 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
895 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
896 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
897 @end defmac
898
899 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
900 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
901 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
902 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
903 @end defmac
904
905 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
906 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
907 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
908 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
909 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
910 @end defmac
911
912 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
913 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
914 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
915 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
916 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
917 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
918 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
919
920 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
921 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
922 @end defmac
923
924 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
925 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
926 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
927 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
928 scalar type.
929
930 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
931 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
932 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
933 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
934 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
935 counterparts.
936
937 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
938 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
939 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
940 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
941 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
942 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
943
944 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
945 @end defmac
946
947 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
948 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
949 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
950 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
951 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
952 pointer} types.
953
954 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
955 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
956 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
957 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
958 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
959 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
960 the signedness may be different.
961
962 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
963
964 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
965 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
966 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
967 @end deftypefn
968
969 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
970 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
971 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
972 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
973 size of an integer.
974 @end defmac
975
976 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
977 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
978 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
979 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
980 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
981 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
982 @end defmac
983
984 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
985 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
986 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
987 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
988 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
989 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
990 @end defmac
991
992 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
993 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
994 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
995 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
996 @end defmac
997
998 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
999 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1000 @end defmac
1001
1002 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1003 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1004 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1005 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1006 @end defmac
1007
1008 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1009 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1010 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1011 @end defmac
1012
1013 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1014 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1015 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1016 @end defmac
1017
1018 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1019 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1020 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1021 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1022 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1023 @end defmac
1024
1025 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1026 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1027 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1028 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1029 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1030 @end defmac
1031
1032 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1033 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1034 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1035 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1036 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1037 field alignment has not been set by the
1038 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1039 @end defmac
1040
1041 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1042 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1043 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1044
1045 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1046
1047 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1048 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1049 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1050 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1051 @end defmac
1052
1053 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1054 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1055 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1056 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1057 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1058
1059 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1060 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1061 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1062 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1063 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1064 @end defmac
1065
1066 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1067 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1068 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1069 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1070 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1071
1072 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1073
1074 @findex strcpy
1075 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1076 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1077 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1078 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1079 @end defmac
1080
1081 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1082 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1083 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1084 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1085 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1086
1087 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1088 @end defmac
1089
1090 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1091 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1092 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1093 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1094 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1095 align the object.
1096
1097 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1098
1099 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1100 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1101 constants can be done inline.
1102 @end defmac
1103
1104 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1105 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1106 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1107 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1108 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1109
1110 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1111
1112 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1113 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1114
1115 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1116 @end defmac
1117
1118 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1119 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1120 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1121 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1122 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1123 the vector element type.
1124 @end deftypefn
1125
1126 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1127 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1128 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1129 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1130 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1131 align the slot.
1132
1133 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1134 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1135 be used.
1136
1137 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1138 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1139
1140 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1141 @end defmac
1142
1143 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1144 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1145 variable @var{decl}.
1146
1147 If this macro is not defined, then
1148 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1149 is used.
1150
1151 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1152 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1153
1154 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1158 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1159 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1160 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1161
1162 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1163 @end defmac
1164
1165 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1166 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1167 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1168
1169 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1173 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1174 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1175
1176 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1177 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1178 @end defmac
1179
1180 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1181 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1182 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1183 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1184 @end defmac
1185
1186 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1187 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1188 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1189
1190 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1191 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1192 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1193 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1194 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1195
1196 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1197 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1198 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1199 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1200
1201 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1202 structure.
1203
1204 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1205 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1206
1207 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1208 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1209 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1210 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1211
1212 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1213 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1214 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1215
1216 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1217 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1218 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1219
1220 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1221 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1222 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1223
1224 @smallexample
1225 struct foo1
1226 @{
1227 char x;
1228 char :0;
1229 char y;
1230 @};
1231
1232 struct foo2
1233 @{
1234 char x;
1235 int :0;
1236 char y;
1237 @};
1238
1239 main ()
1240 @{
1241 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1242 sizeof (struct foo1));
1243 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1244 sizeof (struct foo2));
1245 exit (0);
1246 @}
1247 @end smallexample
1248
1249 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1250 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1251 @end defmac
1252
1253 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1254 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1255 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1256 @end defmac
1257
1258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1259 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1260 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1261 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1262 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1263 @end deftypefn
1264
1265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1266 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1267 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1268 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1269
1270 The default is @code{false}.
1271 @end deftypefn
1272
1273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1274 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1275 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1276
1277 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1278 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1279 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1280 retain the field's mode.
1281
1282 Normally, this is not needed.
1283 @end deftypefn
1284
1285 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1286 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1287 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1288 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1289 @var{specified}.
1290
1291 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1292 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1296 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1297 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1298 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1299 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1300 (DImode)} is assumed.
1301 @end defmac
1302
1303 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1304 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1305 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1306 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1307 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1308 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1309 having its mode specified.
1310
1311 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1312 would most commonly define this macro if the
1313 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1314 64-bit mode.
1315 @end defmac
1316
1317 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1318 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1319 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1320 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1321
1322 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1323 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1324 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1325 @end defmac
1326
1327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1328 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1329 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1330 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1331 targets.
1332 @end deftypefn
1333
1334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1335 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1336 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1337 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1338 targets.
1339 @end deftypefn
1340
1341 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1342 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1343 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1344 @end deftypefn
1345
1346 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1347 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1348 mode is towards zero.
1349
1350 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1351 floating-point arithmetic.
1352
1353 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1354 @end defmac
1355
1356 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1357 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1358 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1359 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1360
1361 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1362 floating-point arithmetic.
1363
1364 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1365 @end defmac
1366
1367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1368 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1369 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1370 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1371 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1372 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1373 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1374 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1375 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1376 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1377 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1378 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1379
1380 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1381 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1382 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1383 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1384 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1385 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1386 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1387
1388 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1389 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1390 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1391 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1392 may affect its placement.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1396 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1397 @end deftypefn
1398
1399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1400 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1401 @end deftypefn
1402
1403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1404 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1405 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1406 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1407 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1408 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1409 usage.
1410 @end deftypefn
1411
1412 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1413 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1414 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1415 @end deftypefn
1416
1417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1418 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1419 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1420 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1421 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1422 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1423 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1424 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1425 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1426 string constant.
1427
1428 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1429 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1430 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1431 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1432 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1433 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1434 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1435 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1436 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1437 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1438 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1439 spaces in your string.
1440
1441 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1442 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1443 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1444 before mangling.
1445
1446 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1447 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1448 types.
1449 @end deftypefn
1450
1451 @node Type Layout
1452 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1453
1454 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1455 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1456 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1457 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1458
1459 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1460 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1461 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @end defmac
1463
1464 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1465 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1466 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1467 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1468 unit.)
1469 @end defmac
1470
1471 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1472 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1473 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1478 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1479 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1480 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1481 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1485 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1486 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1488 macro must be at least 64.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1494 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1495 @end defmac
1496
1497 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1498 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1499 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1500 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1501 @end defmac
1502
1503 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1504 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1505 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1510 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1511 words.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1517 words.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1557 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1558 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1559 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1560 @end defmac
1561
1562 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1563 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1564 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1565 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1566 @end defmac
1567
1568 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1569 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1570 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1571 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1572 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1573 @end defmac
1574
1575 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1576 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1577 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1578 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1581 otherwise it is 0.
1582 @end defmac
1583
1584 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1585 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1586 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1587 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1588 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1589 @end defmac
1590
1591 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1592 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1593 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1594 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1595 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1596 @end defmac
1597
1598 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1599 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1600 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1601 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1602 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1603 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1604 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1605 @end defmac
1606
1607 @defmac SF_SIZE
1608 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1609 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1610 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1611 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1612 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1613 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1614 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1615 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1616 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1617 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1618 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1619 @end defmac
1620
1621 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1622 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1623 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1624 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1625 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1626 @end defmac
1627
1628 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1629 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1630 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1631 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1632 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1633 is the default.
1634 @end defmac
1635
1636 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1637 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1638 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1639 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1640 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1644 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1645 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1646 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1647 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1648
1649 The default is to return false.
1650 @end deftypefn
1651
1652 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1653 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1654 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1655 contents of the string.
1656
1657 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1658 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1659 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1660 of the data type names defined in the function
1661 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1662 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1663 compiler to crash on startup.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1666 int"}.
1667 @end defmac
1668
1669 @defmac SIZETYPE
1670 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1671 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1672 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1673 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1674 is extracted.
1675
1676 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1677
1678 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1679 @end defmac
1680
1681 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1682 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1683 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1684 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1685 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1686
1687 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1688 @end defmac
1689
1690 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1691 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1692 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1693 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1694 information.
1695
1696 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1697 @end defmac
1698
1699 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1700 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1701 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1702 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1703 @end defmac
1704
1705 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1706 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1707 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1708 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1709 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1710 information.
1711
1712 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1713 @end defmac
1714
1715 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1716 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1717 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1718 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1719 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1720
1721 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1722 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1723 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1724 @end defmac
1725
1726 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1727 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1728 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1729 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1730 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1731
1732 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1733 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1734 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1735 int}.
1736 @end defmac
1737
1738 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1739 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1740 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1741 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1742 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1743 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1744 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1745 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1746 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1747 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1748 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1749 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1750 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1751 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1753 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1754 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1755 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1756 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1757 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1758 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1759 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1760 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1761 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1762 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1763 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1764 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1765 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1766 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1767 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1768 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1769 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1770 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1771 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1772 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1773 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1774 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1775
1776 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1777 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1778 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1779 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1780 these macros are null pointers.
1781 @end defmac
1782
1783 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1784 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1785 that looks like:
1786
1787 @smallexample
1788 struct @{
1789 union @{
1790 void (*fn)();
1791 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1792 @};
1793 ptrdiff_t delta;
1794 @};
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1799 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1800 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1801 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1802 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1803 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1804 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1805 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1806
1807 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1808 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1809 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1810 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1811 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1812 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1813 architecture, you should define this macro to
1814 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1815
1816 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1817 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1818 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1819 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1820 @end defmac
1821
1822 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1823 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1824 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1825 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1826 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1827 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1828 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1829
1830 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1831 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1832 @end defmac
1833
1834 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1835 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1836 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1837 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1838 when special alignment is necessary. */
1839 @end defmac
1840
1841 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1842 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1843 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1844 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1845 of words in each data entry.
1846 @end defmac
1847
1848 @node Registers
1849 @section Register Usage
1850 @cindex register usage
1851
1852 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1853 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1854
1855 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1856 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1857 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1858 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1859 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1860
1861 @menu
1862 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1863 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1864 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1865 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1866 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1867 @end menu
1868
1869 @node Register Basics
1870 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1871
1872 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1873 Registers have various characteristics.
1874
1875 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1876 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1877 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1878 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1879 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1880 @end defmac
1881
1882 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1883 @cindex fixed register
1884 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1885 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1886 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1887 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1888 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1889 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1890 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1891
1892 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1893 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1894 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1895
1896 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1897 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1898 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1899 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1900 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1901 @end defmac
1902
1903 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1904 @cindex call-used register
1905 @cindex call-clobbered register
1906 @cindex call-saved register
1907 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1908 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1909 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1910 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1911 function calls.
1912
1913 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1914 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1915 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1916 @end defmac
1917
1918 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1919 @cindex call-used register
1920 @cindex call-clobbered register
1921 @cindex call-saved register
1922 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1923 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1924 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1925 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1926 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1927 @end defmac
1928
1929 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1930 @cindex call-used register
1931 @cindex call-clobbered register
1932 @cindex call-saved register
1933 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1934 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1935 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1936 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1937 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1938 @end defmac
1939
1940 @findex fixed_regs
1941 @findex call_used_regs
1942 @findex global_regs
1943 @findex reg_names
1944 @findex reg_class_contents
1945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1946 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1947 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1948 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1949 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1950 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1951 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1952 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1953 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1954 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1955 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1956 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1957 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1958 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1959 command options have been applied.
1960
1961 @cindex disabling certain registers
1962 @cindex controlling register usage
1963 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1964 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1965 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1966 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1967 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1968 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1969 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1970
1971 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1972 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1973 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1974 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1975 @end deftypefn
1976
1977 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1978 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1979 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1980 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1981 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1982 outbound register.
1983 @end defmac
1984
1985 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1986 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1987 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1988 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1989 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1990 register.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1994 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1995 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1996 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1997 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1998 gotos.
1999 @end defmac
2000
2001 @defmac PC_REGNUM
2002 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2003 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2004 @end defmac
2005
2006 @node Allocation Order
2007 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2008 @cindex order of register allocation
2009 @cindex register allocation order
2010
2011 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2012 Registers are allocated in order.
2013
2014 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2015 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2016 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2017 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2018
2019 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2020 (all else being equal).
2021
2022 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2023 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2024 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2025 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2026 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2027 @end defmac
2028
2029 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2030 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2031 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2032
2033 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2034 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2035 register; and so on.
2036
2037 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2038 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2039
2040 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2041 @end defmac
2042
2043 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2044 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2045 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2046 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2047 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2048 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2049 should be defined.
2050 @end defmac
2051
2052 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2053 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2054 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2055 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2056 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2057 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2058 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2059 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2060
2061 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2062 @end defmac
2063
2064 @node Values in Registers
2065 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2066
2067 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2068 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2069 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2070
2071 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2072 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2073 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2074 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2075 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2076 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2077
2078 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2079 definition of this macro is
2080
2081 @smallexample
2082 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2083 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2084 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2085 @end smallexample
2086 @end defmac
2087
2088 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2089 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2090 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2091 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2092 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2093 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2094 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2095
2096 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2097 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2098 nonzero.
2099
2100 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2101 @code{subreg_get_info}
2102 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2103 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2104 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2105 registers and so not be representable.
2106 @end defmac
2107
2108 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2109 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2110 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2111 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2112 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2113 @end defmac
2114
2115 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2116 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2117 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2118 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2119 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2120 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2121 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2122 @end defmac
2123
2124 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2125 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2126 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2127 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2128 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2129
2130 @smallexample
2131 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2132 @end smallexample
2133
2134 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2135 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2136
2137 @cindex register pairs
2138 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2139 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2140 odd register numbers for such modes.
2141
2142 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2143 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2144 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2145 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2146
2147 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2148 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2149 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2150 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2151 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2152 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2153 to be tieable.
2154
2155 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2156 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2157 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2158 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2159 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2160 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2161
2162 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2163 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2164 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2165 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2166 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2167 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2168 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2169 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2170 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2171
2172 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2173 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2174 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2175 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2176 constraints for those instructions.
2177
2178 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2179 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2180 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2181 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2182 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2183 @end defmac
2184
2185 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2186 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2187 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2188
2189 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2190 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2191 handler.
2192
2193 The default is always nonzero.
2194 @end defmac
2195
2196 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2197 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2198 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2199
2200 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2201 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2202 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2203 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2204 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2205 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2206
2207 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2208 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2209 allocation.
2210 @end defmac
2211
2212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2213 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2214 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2215
2216 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2217 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2218
2219 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2220 @end deftypefn
2221
2222 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2223 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2224 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2225 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2226 @end defmac
2227
2228 @node Leaf Functions
2229 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2230
2231 @cindex leaf functions
2232 @cindex functions, leaf
2233 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2234 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2235 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2236 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2237 normally arrive.
2238
2239 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2240 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2241 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2242 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2243 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2244 functions''.
2245
2246 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2247 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2248 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2249 accomplish this.
2250
2251 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2252 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2253 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2254 function treatment.
2255
2256 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2257 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2258 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2259 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2260 in this vector.
2261
2262 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2263 the treatment of leaf functions.
2264 @end defmac
2265
2266 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2267 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2268 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2269
2270 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2271 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2272 will cause the compiler to abort.
2273
2274 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2275 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2276 this.
2277 @end defmac
2278
2279 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2280 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2281 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2282 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2283 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2284 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2285 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2286 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2287 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2288 functions which only use leaf registers.
2289 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2290 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2291 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2292 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2293 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2294
2295 @node Stack Registers
2296 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2297
2298 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2299 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2300 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2301 stack.
2302
2303 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2304 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2305 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2306 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2307 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2308 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2309 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2310
2311 @defmac STACK_REGS
2312 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2316 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2317 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2318 @end defmac
2319
2320 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2321 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2322 of the stack.
2323 @end defmac
2324
2325 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2326 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2327 the stack.
2328 @end defmac
2329
2330 @node Register Classes
2331 @section Register Classes
2332 @cindex register class definitions
2333 @cindex class definitions, register
2334
2335 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2336 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2337 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2338 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2339
2340 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2341 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2342 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2343
2344 @findex ALL_REGS
2345 @findex NO_REGS
2346 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2347 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2348 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2349 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2350
2351 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2352 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2353 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2354 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2355 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2356 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2357
2358 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2359 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2360
2361 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2362 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2363 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2364 them in operand constraints.
2365
2366 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2367 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2368 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2369 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2370 (@pxref{Costs}).
2371
2372 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2373 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2374 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2375 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2376 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2377 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2378 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2379
2380 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2381 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2382 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2383 in their union.
2384
2385 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2386 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2387 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2388 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2389 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2390
2391 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2392 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2393 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2394 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2395 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2396 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2397 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2398 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2399 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2400
2401 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2402 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2403 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2404 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2405 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2406 tells how many classes there are.
2407
2408 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2409 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2410 in many of the tables described below.
2411 @end deftp
2412
2413 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2414 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2415
2416 @smallexample
2417 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2418 @end smallexample
2419 @end defmac
2420
2421 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2422 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2423 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2424 @end defmac
2425
2426 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2427 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2428 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2429 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2430 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2431
2432 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2433 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2434 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2435 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2436 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2437 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2438 so on.
2439 @end defmac
2440
2441 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2442 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2443 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2444 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2445 register.
2446 @end defmac
2447
2448 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2449 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2450 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2451 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2452 @end defmac
2453
2454 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2455 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2456 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2457 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2458 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2459 @end defmac
2460
2461 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2462 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2463 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2464 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2465 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2466 @end defmac
2467
2468 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2469 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2470 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2471 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2472 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2473 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2474 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2475 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2476 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2477 @end defmac
2478
2479 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2480 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2481 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2482 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2483 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2484 @end defmac
2485
2486 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2487 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2488 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2489 @end defmac
2490
2491 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2492 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2493 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2494 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2495 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2496 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2497 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2498 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2499 @code{address_operand}.
2500 @end defmac
2501
2502 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2503 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2504 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2505 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2506 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2507 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2508 than other base register uses.
2509
2510 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2511 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2512 @end defmac
2513
2514 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2515 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2516 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2517 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2518 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2519 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2520 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2521 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2522 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2523 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2524 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2525 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2526 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2527 @end defmac
2528
2529 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2530 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2531 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2532 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2533 allocated such a hard register.
2534
2535 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2536 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2537 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2538 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2539 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2540 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2541 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2542 only if neither labeling works.
2543 @end defmac
2544
2545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2546 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2547 @end deftypefn
2548
2549 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2550 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2551 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2552 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2553 another, smaller class.
2554
2555 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2556
2557 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2558 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2559 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2560 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2561 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2562
2563 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2564 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2565 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2566 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2567 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2568 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2569 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2570 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2571 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2572 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2573 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2574
2575 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2576 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2577 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2578 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2579 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2580 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2581 @end deftypefn
2582
2583 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2584 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2585 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2586 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2587 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2588 safe:
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2592 @end smallexample
2593
2594 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2595 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2596 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2597 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2598 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2599
2600 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2601 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2602 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2603 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2604 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2605 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2606 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2607 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2608 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2609 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2610 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2611
2612 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2613 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2614 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2615 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2616 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2617 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2618 @end defmac
2619
2620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2621 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2622 input reloads.
2623
2624 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2625 argument.
2626
2627 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2628 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2629 @end deftypefn
2630
2631 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2632 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2633 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2634 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2635 ordinarily be used.
2636
2637 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2638 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2639
2640 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2641 smaller class.
2642
2643 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2644 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2645 @end defmac
2646
2647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2648 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2649 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2650 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2651 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2652 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2653 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2654 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2655 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2656 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2657 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2658 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2659 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2660
2661 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2662 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2663 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2664 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2665 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2666 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2667 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2668 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2669 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2670 of the scratch register(s).
2671
2672 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2673
2674 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2675 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2676 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2677 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2678 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2679
2680 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2681 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2682 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2683 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2684 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2685 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2686
2687 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2688 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2689 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2690 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2691 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2692
2693 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2694 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2695 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2696 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2697 single-register-class
2698 @c [later: or memory]
2699 output constraint.
2700
2701 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2702 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2703 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2704 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2705
2706 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2707 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2708 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2709 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2710 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2711 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2712 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2713 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2714
2715
2716 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2717 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2718 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2719 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2720
2721 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2722 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2723 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2724
2725 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2726 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2727 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2728 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2729 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2730 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2731 @end deftypefn
2732
2733 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2734 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2735 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2736 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2737 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2738
2739 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2740 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2741 reload phase that it may
2742 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2743 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2744 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2745 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2746 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2747 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2748
2749 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2750 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2751 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2752 class required. If the
2753 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2754 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2755 macros identically.
2756
2757 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2758 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2759 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2760 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2761 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2762
2763 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2764 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2765 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2766 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2767 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2768 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2769 register.
2770
2771 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2772 register that
2773 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2774 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2775 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2776 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2777 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2778
2779 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2780 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2781 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2782 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2783
2784 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2785 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2786 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2787 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2788 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2789 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2790 general registers.
2791 @end defmac
2792
2793 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2794 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2795 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2796 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2797 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2798 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2799 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2800
2801 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2802 @end defmac
2803
2804 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2805 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2806 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2807 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2808 defined by this macro.
2809
2810 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2811 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2812 @end defmac
2813
2814 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2815 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2816 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2817 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2818 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2819 same as that of @var{mode}.
2820
2821 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2822 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2823 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2824 registers.
2825
2826 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2827 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2828 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2829 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2830 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2831 details.
2832
2833 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2834 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2835 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2836 @end defmac
2837
2838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2839 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2840 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2841 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2842
2843 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2844 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2845 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2846 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2847 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2848
2849 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2850 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2851 pressure.
2852 @end deftypefn
2853
2854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2855 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2856 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2857
2858 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2859 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2860 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2861 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2862 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2863
2864 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2865 in the reload pass.
2866
2867 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2868 in words.
2869 @end deftypefn
2870
2871 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2872 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2873 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2874
2875 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2876 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2877 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2878 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2879
2880 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2881 in the reload pass.
2882 @end defmac
2883
2884 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2885 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2886 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2887
2888 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2889 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2890 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2891 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2892 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2893 as below:
2894
2895 @smallexample
2896 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2897 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2898 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2899 @end smallexample
2900 @end defmac
2901
2902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2903 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2904 @end deftypefn
2905
2906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2907 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2908 @end deftypefn
2909
2910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2911 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2912 @end deftypefn
2913
2914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2915 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2916 @end deftypefn
2917
2918 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2919 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2920 @end deftypefn
2921
2922 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2923 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2924 @end deftypefn
2925
2926 @node Old Constraints
2927 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2928 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2929 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2930
2931 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2932 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2933 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2934 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2935
2936 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2937 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2938 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2939 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2940 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2941 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2942 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2943 to handle specially.
2944 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2945 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2946 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2947 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2948 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2949 @end defmac
2950
2951 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2952 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2953 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2954 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2955 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2956 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2957 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2958 @end defmac
2959
2960 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2961 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2962 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2963 different variants.
2964 @end defmac
2965
2966 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2967 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2968 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2969 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2970 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2971 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2972 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2973 @var{value}.
2974 @end defmac
2975
2976 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2977 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2978 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2979 between different variants.
2980 @end defmac
2981
2982 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2983 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2984 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2985 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2986
2987 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2988 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2989 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2990 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2991
2992 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2993 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2994 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2995 between these kinds.
2996 @end defmac
2997
2998 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2999 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3000 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3001 between different variants.
3002 @end defmac
3003
3004 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
3005 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3006 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
3007 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
3008 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3009 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3010 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3011
3012 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3013 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3014 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3015 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3016
3017 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3018 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3019 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3020 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3021 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3022 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3023 does not include r0 on the output.
3024 @end defmac
3025
3026 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3027 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3028 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3029 variants.
3030 @end defmac
3031
3032 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3033 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3034 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3035 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3036
3037 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3038 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3039 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3040 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3041 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3042 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3043
3044 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3045 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3046 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3047 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3048 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3049 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3050 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3051 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3052 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3053 @end defmac
3054
3055 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3056 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3057 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3058 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3059 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3060
3061 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3062 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3063 a subset of all memory addresses including
3064 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3065 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3066 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3067
3068 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3069 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3070 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3071 @end defmac
3072
3073 @node Stack and Calling
3074 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3075 @cindex calling conventions
3076
3077 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3078 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3079
3080 @menu
3081 * Frame Layout::
3082 * Exception Handling::
3083 * Stack Checking::
3084 * Frame Registers::
3085 * Elimination::
3086 * Stack Arguments::
3087 * Register Arguments::
3088 * Scalar Return::
3089 * Aggregate Return::
3090 * Caller Saves::
3091 * Function Entry::
3092 * Profiling::
3093 * Tail Calls::
3094 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3095 @end menu
3096
3097 @node Frame Layout
3098 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3099 @cindex stack frame layout
3100 @cindex frame layout
3101
3102 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3103 Here is the basic stack layout.
3104
3105 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3106 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3107 pointer to a smaller address.
3108
3109 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3110 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3111 definition used does not matter.
3112 @end defmac
3113
3114 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3115 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3116 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3117 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3118
3119 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3120 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3121 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3122 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3123 space for the next item on the stack.
3124
3125 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3126 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3127 which is often wrong.
3128 @end defmac
3129
3130 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3131 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3132 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3133 @end defmac
3134
3135 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3136 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3137 addresses on the stack.
3138 @end defmac
3139
3140 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3141 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3142
3143 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3144 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3145 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3146 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3147 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3148 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3149 @end defmac
3150
3151 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3152 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3153 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3154
3155 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3156 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3157 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3158 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3159 @end defmac
3160
3161 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3162 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3163 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3164 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3165
3166 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3167 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3168 @end defmac
3169
3170 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3171 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3172 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3173 function.
3174
3175 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3176 the first argument's address.
3177 @end defmac
3178
3179 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3180 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3181 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3182
3183 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3184 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3185 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3186 @end defmac
3187
3188 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3189 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3190 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3191 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3192 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3193 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3194 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3195 @end defmac
3196
3197 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3198 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3199 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3200 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3201 itself.
3202
3203 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3204 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3205 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3206 @end defmac
3207
3208 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3209 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3210 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3211 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3212 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3213 define this macro.
3214 @end defmac
3215
3216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3217 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3218 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3219 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3220 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3221 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3222 @end deftypefn
3223
3224 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3225 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3226 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3227 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3228 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3229 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3230 @end defmac
3231
3232 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3233 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3234 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3235 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3236 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3237 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3238
3239 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3240 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3241 determine the return address of other frames.
3242 @end defmac
3243
3244 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3245 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3246 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3247 @end defmac
3248
3249 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3250 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3251 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3252 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3253 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3254 the stack.
3255
3256 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3257 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3258
3259 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3260 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3261 @end defmac
3262
3263 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3264 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3265 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3266 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3267 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3268
3269 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3270 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3271 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3272 over time.
3273 @end defmac
3274
3275 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3276 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3277 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3278 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3279 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3280 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3281 @end defmac
3282
3283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3284 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3285 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3286 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3287 @smallexample
3288 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3289 @end smallexample
3290 and
3291 @smallexample
3292 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3293 @end smallexample
3294 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3295 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3296 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3297 @end deftypefn
3298
3299 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3300 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3301 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3302 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3303 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3304 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3305
3306 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3307 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3308 @end defmac
3309
3310 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3311 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3312 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3313 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3314 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3315 during virtual register instantiation.
3316
3317 The default value for this macro is
3318 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3319 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3320 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3321 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3322 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3323
3324 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3325 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3326 DWARF 2.
3327 @end defmac
3328
3329 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3330 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3331 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3332 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3333 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3334
3335 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3336 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3337 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3338 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3339 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3340 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3341 should be defined.
3342 @end defmac
3343
3344 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3345 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3346 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3347 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3348 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3349 @end defmac
3350
3351 @node Exception Handling
3352 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3353 @cindex exception handling
3354
3355 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3356 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3357 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3358 @var{N} registers are usable.
3359
3360 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3361 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3362 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3363 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3364 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3365
3366 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3367 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3368 @end defmac
3369
3370 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3371 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3372 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3373 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3374 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3375
3376 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3377 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3378
3379 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3380 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3381 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3382 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3383 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3384 that provided by DWARF 2.
3385 @end defmac
3386
3387 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3388 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3389 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3390 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3391
3392 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3393 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3394 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3395 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3396 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3397 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3398 target call frame.
3399
3400 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3401 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3402 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3403
3404 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3405 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3406 @end defmac
3407
3408 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3409 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3410 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3411 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3412 using it to return to the exception handler.
3413 @end defmac
3414
3415 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3416 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3417 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3418 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3419 and so may be read-only.
3420
3421 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3422 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3423 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3424 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3425
3426 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3427 represented directly.
3428 @end defmac
3429
3430 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3431 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3432 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3433 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3434 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3435
3436 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3437 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3438 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3439 to be emitted.
3440 @end defmac
3441
3442 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3443 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3444 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3445 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3446 through signal frames.
3447
3448 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3449 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3450 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3451 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3452 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3453 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3454 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3455 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3456 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3457
3458 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3459 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3460 @end defmac
3461
3462 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3463 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3464 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3465 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3466
3467 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3468 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3469 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3470 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3471 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3472 be updated in @var{fs}.
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3476 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3477 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3478 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3479 @end defmac
3480
3481 @node Stack Checking
3482 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3483
3484 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3485 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3486 three ways:
3487
3488 @enumerate
3489 @item
3490 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3491 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3492 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3493 other special processing.
3494
3495 @item
3496 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3497 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3498 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3499 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3500 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3501 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3502 approach below.
3503
3504 @item
3505 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3506 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3507 @end enumerate
3508
3509 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3510 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3511 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3512 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3513
3514 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3515 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3516 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3517 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3518 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3519 value of this macro is zero.
3520 @end defmac
3521
3522 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3523 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3524 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3525 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3526 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3527 @end defmac
3528
3529 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3530 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3531 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3532 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3533 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3534 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3535 @end defmac
3536
3537 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3538 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3539 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3540 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3541 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3542 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3543 default value of this macro is zero.
3544 @end defmac
3545
3546 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3547 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3548 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3549 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3550 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3551 most machines.
3552 @end defmac
3553
3554 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3555 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3556 in the opposite case.
3557
3558 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3559 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3560 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3561 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3562 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3563 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3564 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3565 @end defmac
3566
3567 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3568 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3569 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3570 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3571 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3572 use the default of four words.
3573 @end defmac
3574
3575 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3576 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3577 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3578 @option{-fstack-check}.
3579 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3580 normally not need to override that default.
3581 @end defmac
3582
3583 @need 2000
3584 @node Frame Registers
3585 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3586
3587 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3588 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3589
3590 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3591 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3592 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3593 the hardware determines which register this is.
3594 @end defmac
3595
3596 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3597 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3598 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3599 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3600 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3601 @end defmac
3602
3603 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3604 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3605 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3606 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3607 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3608 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3609 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3610 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3611 used for the frame pointer.
3612
3613 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3614 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3615 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3616 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3617 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3618 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3619 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3620
3621 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3622 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3623 @end defmac
3624
3625 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3626 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3627 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3628 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3629 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3630 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3631 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3632 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3633 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3634 @end defmac
3635
3636 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3637 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3638 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3639 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3640 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3641 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3642 @end defmac
3643
3644 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3645 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3646 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3647 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3648 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3649 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3650 @end defmac
3651
3652 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3653 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3654 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3655 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3656 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3657 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3658 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3659
3660 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3661 address from the stack.
3662 @end defmac
3663
3664 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3665 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3666 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3667 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3668 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3669 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3670 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3671 not be defined.
3672
3673 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3674
3675 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3676 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3677 @end defmac
3678
3679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3680 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3681 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3682 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3683 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3684 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3685
3686 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3687
3688 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3689 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3690 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3691 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3692 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3693 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3694 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3695 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3696 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3697 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3698 to refer to those items.
3699 @end deftypefn
3700
3701 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3702 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3703 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3704 DWARF2 exception handling.
3705
3706 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3707 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3708 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3709 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3710 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3711 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3712 registers that are not call-saved.
3713
3714 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3715 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3716 @end defmac
3717
3718 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3719
3720 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3721 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3722
3723 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3724 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3725 @end defmac
3726
3727 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3728
3729 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3730 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3731 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3732 column number to use instead.
3733
3734 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3735 @end defmac
3736
3737 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3738
3739 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3740 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3741 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3742 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3743 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3744
3745 @end defmac
3746
3747 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3748
3749 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3750 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3751 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3752 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3753 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3754
3755 @end defmac
3756
3757 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3758
3759 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3760 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3761 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3762 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3763
3764 @end defmac
3765
3766 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3767
3768 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3769 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3770 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3771 defined and 0 otherwise.
3772
3773 @end defmac
3774
3775 @node Elimination
3776 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3777
3778 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3779 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3780
3781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3782 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3783 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3784 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3785
3786 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3787 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3788 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3789 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3790 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3791 pointer.
3792
3793 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3794 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3795 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3796 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3797 them.
3798
3799 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3800 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3801 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3802
3803 Default return value is @code{false}.
3804 @end deftypefn
3805
3806 @findex get_frame_size
3807 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3808 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3809 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3810 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3811 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3812 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3813
3814 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3815 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3816 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3817 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3818 @end defmac
3819
3820 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3821 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3822 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3823 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3824 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3825
3826 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3827 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3828
3829 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3830 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3831 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3832 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3833 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3834
3835 In this case, you might specify:
3836 @smallexample
3837 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3838 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3839 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3840 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3841 @end smallexample
3842
3843 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3844 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3845 @end defmac
3846
3847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3848 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3849 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3850 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3851 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3852 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3853 knows about.
3854
3855 Default return value is @code{true}.
3856 @end deftypefn
3857
3858 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3859 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3860 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3861 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3862 defined.
3863 @end defmac
3864
3865 @node Stack Arguments
3866 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3867 @cindex arguments on stack
3868 @cindex stack arguments
3869
3870 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3871 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3872 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3873
3874 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3875 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3876 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3877 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3878 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3879 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3880 @end deftypefn
3881
3882 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3883 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3884 outgoing arguments.
3885 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3886 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3887 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3888 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3889 @end defmac
3890
3891 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3892 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3893 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3894 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3895 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3896 @end defmac
3897
3898 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3899 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3900 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3901
3902 On some machines, the definition
3903
3904 @smallexample
3905 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3906 @end smallexample
3907
3908 @noindent
3909 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3910 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3911 alignment. Then the definition should be
3912
3913 @smallexample
3914 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3915 @end smallexample
3916
3917 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3918 @end defmac
3919
3920 @findex outgoing_args_size
3921 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3922 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3923 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3924 will be computed and placed into
3925 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3926 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3927 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3928
3929 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3930 is not proper.
3931 @end defmac
3932
3933 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3934 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3935 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3936 registers.
3937
3938 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3939 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3940 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3941 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3942 of the function.
3943
3944 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3945 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3946 which.
3947 @end defmac
3948 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3949 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3950
3951 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3952 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3953 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3954 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3955 if the function called is a library function.
3956
3957 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3958 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3959 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3960 @end defmac
3961
3962 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3963 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3964 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3965 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3966 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3967
3968 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3969 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3970 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3971 stack in its natural location.
3972 @end defmac
3973
3974 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3975 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3976 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3977 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3978
3979 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3980 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3981 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3982 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3983
3984 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3985 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3986 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3987 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3988 arguments (if known).
3989
3990 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3991 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3992 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3993 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3994 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3995 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3996
3997 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3998 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3999 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
4000
4001 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
4002 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
4003 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
4004 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
4005 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
4006 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
4007 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
4008 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
4009 number of arguments.
4010 @end deftypefn
4011
4012 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
4013 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4014 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4015 when compiling a function call.
4016
4017 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4018 have been accumulated.
4019
4020 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4021 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4022 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4023 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4024 appropriate.
4025 @end defmac
4026
4027 @node Register Arguments
4028 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4029 @cindex arguments in registers
4030 @cindex registers arguments
4031
4032 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4033 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4034 the stack.
4035
4036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4037 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4038 register and if so, which register.
4039
4040 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4041 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4042 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4043 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4044 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4045 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4046 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4047 syntax error has previously occurred.
4048
4049 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4050 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4051 on the stack.
4052
4053 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4054 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4055 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4056 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4057 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4058 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4059 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4060 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4061 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4062 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4063 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4064 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4065 argument is also stored on the stack.
4066
4067 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4068 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4069 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4070
4071 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4072 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4073 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4074 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4075 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4076 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4077
4078 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4079 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4080 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4081 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4082 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4083 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4084 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4085 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4086 a register.
4087 @end deftypefn
4088
4089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4090 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4091 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4092 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4093 documentation.
4094 @end deftypefn
4095
4096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4097 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4098 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4099 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4100 argument.
4101
4102 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4103 which the caller passes the value, and
4104 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4105 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4106 arrive.
4107
4108 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4109 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4110 @end deftypefn
4111
4112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4113 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4114 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4115 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4116 pushed on the stack.
4117
4118 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4119 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4120 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4121 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4122 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4123 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4124 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4125
4126 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4127 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4128 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4129 @end deftypefn
4130
4131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4132 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4133 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4134 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4135 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4136
4137 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4138 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4139 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4140 to that type.
4141 @end deftypefn
4142
4143 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4144 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4145 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4146 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4147 by the caller.
4148
4149 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4150 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4151 not be generated.
4152
4153 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4154 @end deftypefn
4155
4156 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4157 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4158 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4159 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4160 of bytes of argument so far.
4161
4162 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4163 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4164 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4165 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4166 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4167 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4168 @end defmac
4169
4170 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4171 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4172 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4173 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4174 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4175 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4176 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4177 @end defmac
4178
4179 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4180 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4181 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4182 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4183 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4184 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4185 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4186 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4187 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4188 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4189 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4190 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4191 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4192
4193 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4194 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4195 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4196 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4197 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4198 never both of them at once.
4199 @end defmac
4200
4201 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4202 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4203 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4204 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4205 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4206 0)} is used instead.
4207 @end defmac
4208
4209 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4210 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4211 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4212 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4213
4214 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4215 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4216 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4217 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4218 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4219 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4220 @end defmac
4221
4222 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4223 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4224 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4225 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4226 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4227 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4228
4229 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4230 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4231 used for arguments without any special help.
4232 @end deftypefn
4233
4234 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4235 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4236 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4237 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4238 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4239 top.
4240 @end defmac
4241
4242 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4243 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4244 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4245 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4246 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4247
4248 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4249 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4250 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4251
4252 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4253 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4254 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4255 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4256 @end defmac
4257
4258 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4259 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4260 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4261 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4262 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4263 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4264 @end defmac
4265
4266 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4267 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4268 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4269 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4270 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4271 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4272 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4273 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4274 required.
4275 @end defmac
4276
4277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4278 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4279 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4280 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4281 @end deftypefn
4282
4283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4284 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4285 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4286 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4287 value.
4288 @end deftypefn
4289
4290 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4291 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4292 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4293 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4294 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4295 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4296 stack.
4297 @end defmac
4298
4299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4300 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4301 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4302 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4303 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4304 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4305 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4306 point register.
4307
4308 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4309 false.
4310 @end deftypefn
4311
4312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4313 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4314 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4315 @end deftypefn
4316
4317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4318 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4319 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4320 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4321 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4322 variable.
4323 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4324 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4325 internal type.
4326 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4327 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4328 macro to iterate through all types.
4329 @end deftypefn
4330
4331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4332 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4333 @var{fndecl}.
4334 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4335 @end deftypefn
4336
4337 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4338 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4339 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4340 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4341 @end deftypefn
4342
4343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4344 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4345 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4346 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4347 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4348 @end deftypefn
4349
4350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4351 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4352 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4353 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4354 @end deftypefn
4355
4356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4357 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4358 @end deftypefn
4359
4360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4361 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4362 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4363 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4364 must work.
4365
4366 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4367 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4368 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4369 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4370 @end deftypefn
4371
4372 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4373 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4374 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4375 must have move patterns for this mode.
4376 @end deftypefn
4377
4378 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4379 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4380 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4381 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4382 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4383
4384 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4385 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4386 has operations like:
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 where the return type is defined as:
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4396 @{
4397 int8x8_t val[3];
4398 @} int8x8x3_t;
4399 @end smallexample
4400
4401 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4402 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4403 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4404 @end deftypefn
4405
4406 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4407 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4408 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4409 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4410 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4411 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4412 for any mode.
4413
4414 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4415 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4416 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4417 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4418 insn.
4419
4420 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4421 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4422 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4423 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4424 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4425 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4426 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4427 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4428 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4429
4430 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4431 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4432 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4433 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4434 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4435 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4436 @end deftypefn
4437
4438 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4439 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4440 @end deftypevr
4441
4442 @node Scalar Return
4443 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4444 @cindex return values in registers
4445 @cindex values, returned by functions
4446 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4447
4448 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4449 values---values that can fit in registers.
4450
4451 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4452
4453 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4454 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4455 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4456 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4457 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4458 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4459 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4460 a function returns a value.
4461
4462 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4463 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4464 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4465 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4466 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4467 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4468 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4469 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4470 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4471 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4472 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4473 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4474
4475 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4476 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4477 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4478
4479 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4480 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4481 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4482 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4483 known.
4484
4485 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4486 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4487 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4488 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4489
4490 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4491 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4492 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4493 @end deftypefn
4494
4495 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4496 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4497 a new target instead.
4498 @end defmac
4499
4500 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4501 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4502 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4503
4504 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4505 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4506 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4507 compiled.
4508 @end defmac
4509
4510 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4511 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4512 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4513
4514 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4515 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4516 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4517
4518 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4519 @end deftypefn
4520
4521 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4522 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4523 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4524
4525 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4526 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4527 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4528 suffices:
4529
4530 @smallexample
4531 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4532 @end smallexample
4533
4534 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4535 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4536 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4537
4538 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4539 for a new target instead.
4540 @end defmac
4541
4542 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4543 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4544 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4545
4546 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4547 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4548 recognized by this target hook.
4549
4550 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4551 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4552 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4553
4554 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4555 @end deftypefn
4556
4557 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4558 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4559 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4560 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4561 @end defmac
4562
4563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4564 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4565 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4566 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4567 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4568
4569 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4570 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4571 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4572 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4573 @code{SImode} rtx.
4574 @end deftypefn
4575
4576 @node Aggregate Return
4577 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4578 @cindex aggregates as return values
4579 @cindex large return values
4580 @cindex returning aggregate values
4581 @cindex structure value address
4582
4583 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4584 cases), the value is not returned according to
4585 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4586 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4587 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4588 address}.
4589
4590 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4591 memory.
4592
4593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4594 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4595 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4596 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4597 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4598 libcalls.
4599
4600 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4601 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4602 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4603 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4604 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4605 values, and 0 otherwise.
4606
4607 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4608 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4609 to indicate this.
4610 @end deftypefn
4611
4612 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4613 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4614 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4615 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4616 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4617 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4618 target hook.
4619
4620 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4621 @end defmac
4622
4623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4624 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4625 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4626 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4627 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4628 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4629 argument.
4630
4631 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4632 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4633 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4634 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4635 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4636 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4637 the caller.
4638
4639 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4640 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4641 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4642 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4643 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4644 @end deftypefn
4645
4646 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4647 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4648 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4649 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4650
4651 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4652 pass an address to the subroutine.
4653
4654 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4655 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4656 @end defmac
4657
4658 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4659 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4660 @end deftypefn
4661
4662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4663 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4664 @end deftypefn
4665
4666 @node Caller Saves
4667 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4668
4669 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4670 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4671 must live across calls.
4672
4673 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4674 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4675 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4676 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4677 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4678
4679 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4680 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4681 @end defmac
4682
4683 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4684 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4685 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4686 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4687 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4688 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4689 @end defmac
4690
4691 @node Function Entry
4692 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4693 @cindex function entry and exit
4694 @cindex prologue
4695 @cindex epilogue
4696
4697 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4698 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4699
4700 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4701 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4702 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4703 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4704 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4705 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4706 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4707
4708 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4709 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4710
4711 @findex regs_ever_live
4712 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4713 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4714 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4715 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4716 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4717 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4718
4719 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4720 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4721 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4722 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4723 registers are used in the function.
4724
4725 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4726 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4727 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4728 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4729 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4730 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4731 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4732
4733 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4734 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4735 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4736 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4737 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4738 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4739 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4740 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4741 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4742 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4743 @end deftypefn
4744
4745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4746 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4747 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4748 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4749 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4750 @end deftypefn
4751
4752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4753 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4754 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4755 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4756 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4757 @end deftypefn
4758
4759 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4760 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4761 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4762 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4763 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4764 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4765 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4766 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4767
4768 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4769 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4770 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4771 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4772
4773 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4774 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4775 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4776 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4777 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4778 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4779
4780 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4781 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4782 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4783 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4784 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4785 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4786
4787 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4788 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4789 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4790 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4791
4792 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4793 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4794 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4795 number of arguments.
4796
4797 @findex pops_args
4798 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4799 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4800 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4801 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4802 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4803 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4804 @end deftypefn
4805
4806 @itemize @bullet
4807 @item
4808 @findex pretend_args_size
4809 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4810 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4811 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4812 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4813 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4814 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4815 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4816 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4817 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4818 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4819
4820 @item
4821 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4822 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4823 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4824 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4825 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4826 a save area.
4827
4828 @item
4829 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4830 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4831 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4832 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4833
4834 @item
4835 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4836 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4837 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4838 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4839 @end itemize
4840
4841 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4842 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4843 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4844 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4845 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4846 default is 0.
4847
4848 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4849 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4850 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4851 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4852 @end defmac
4853
4854 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4855 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4856 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4857 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4858 @end defmac
4859
4860 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4861 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4862 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4863 on entry to an exception edge.
4864 @end defmac
4865
4866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4867 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4868 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4869 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4870 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4871 the real function.
4872
4873 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4874 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4875 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4876 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4877 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4878 all other incoming arguments.
4879
4880 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4881 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4882 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4883
4884 @smallexample
4885 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4886 @end smallexample
4887
4888 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4889 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4890 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4891 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4892
4893 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4894 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4895 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4896 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4897
4898 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4899 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4900 some targets, but probably not.
4901
4902 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4903 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4904 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4905 not support varargs.
4906 @end deftypefn
4907
4908 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4909 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4910 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4911 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4912 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4913 previously exposed.
4914 @end deftypefn
4915
4916 @node Profiling
4917 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4918 @cindex profiling, code generation
4919
4920 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4921
4922 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4923 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4924 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4925
4926 @findex mcount
4927 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4928 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4929 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4930 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4931
4932 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4933 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4934 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4935 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4936 @end defmac
4937
4938 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4939 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4940 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4941 not support profiling.
4942 @end defmac
4943
4944 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4945 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4946 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4947 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4948 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4949 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4950 @end defmac
4951
4952 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4953 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4954 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4955 @end defmac
4956
4957 @node Tail Calls
4958 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4959 @cindex tail calls
4960
4961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4962 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4963 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4964 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4965
4966 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4967 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4968 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4969 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4970 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4971 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4972 @end deftypefn
4973
4974 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4975 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4976 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4977 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4978 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4979 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4980 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4981 @end deftypefn
4982
4983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4984 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4985 @end deftypefn
4986
4987 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4988 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4989 @end deftypefn
4990
4991 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4992 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4993 @cindex stack smashing protection
4994
4995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4996 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4997 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4998 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4999 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5000 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5001
5002 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5003 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5004 @end deftypefn
5005
5006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5007 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5008 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5009 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5010
5011 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5012 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5013 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5014 @end deftypefn
5015
5016 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5017 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5018 @end deftypefn
5019
5020 @node Varargs
5021 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5022 @cindex varargs implementation
5023
5024 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5025 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5026 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5027 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5028 conditionals to include it.
5029
5030 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5031 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5032 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5033 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5034 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5035 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5036
5037 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5038 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5039 below.
5040
5041 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5042 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5043 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5044 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5045 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5046
5047 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5048 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5049 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5050 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5051
5052 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5053 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5054 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5055 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5056 to use them for its own purposes.
5057 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5058 @c 10feb93
5059 @end defmac
5060
5061 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5062 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5063 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5064 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5065 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5066 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5067 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5068 of the current function.
5069 @end defmac
5070
5071 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5072 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5073 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5074 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5075 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5076 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5077
5078 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5079 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5080 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5081
5082 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5083 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5084 @end defmac
5085
5086 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5087
5088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5089 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5090 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5091 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5092 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5093 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5094 @end deftypefn
5095
5096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5097 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5098 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5099 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5100 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5101 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5102 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5103 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5104
5105 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5106 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5107 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5108 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5109
5110 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5111 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5112 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5113 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5114 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5115 frame.
5116
5117 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5118 compile time without knowing their data types,
5119 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5120 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5121 for all data types.
5122
5123 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5124 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5125 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5126 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5127 not generate any instructions in this case.
5128 @end deftypefn
5129
5130 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5131 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5132 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5133
5134 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5135 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5136 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5137 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5138 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5139 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5140 except the last are treated as named.
5141
5142 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5143 @end deftypefn
5144
5145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5146 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5147 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5148 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5149 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5150 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5151 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5152 @end deftypefn
5153
5154 @node Trampolines
5155 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5156 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5157 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5158
5159 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5160 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5161 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5162 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5163 trampoline.
5164
5165 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5166 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5167 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5168 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5169 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5170 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5171 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5172 operands.
5173
5174 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5175 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5176 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5177 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5178 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5179 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5180 separately.
5181
5182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5183 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5184 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5185 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5186 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5187
5188 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5189 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5190 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5191 to generate it on the spot.
5192 @end deftypefn
5193
5194 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5195 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5196 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5197 @end defmac
5198
5199 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5200 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5201 @end defmac
5202
5203 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5204 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5205
5206 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5207 is used for aligning trampolines.
5208 @end defmac
5209
5210 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5211 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5212 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5213 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5214 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5215 when it is called.
5216
5217 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5218 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5219 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5220 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5221 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5222 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5223
5224 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5225 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5226 initializing the trampoline proper.
5227 @end deftypefn
5228
5229 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5230 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5231 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5232 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5233 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5234 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5235 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5236 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5237 @end deftypefn
5238
5239 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5240 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5241 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5242 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5243
5244 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5245 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5246 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5247 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5248 latter makes initialization faster.
5249
5250 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5251 the following macro.
5252
5253 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5254 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5255 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5256 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5257 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5258 @end defmac
5259
5260 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5261 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5262 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5263 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5264 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5265
5266 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5267 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5268 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5269 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5270 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5271
5272 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5273 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5274 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5275 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5276 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5277 special assembler code.
5278 @end defmac
5279
5280 @node Library Calls
5281 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5282 @cindex library subroutine names
5283 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5284
5285 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5286 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5287
5288 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5289 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5290 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5291 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5292 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5293 @end defmac
5294
5295 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5296 @findex init_one_libfunc
5297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5298 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5299 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5300 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5301 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5302 library routines.
5303
5304 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5305 @end deftypefn
5306
5307 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5308 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5309 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5310 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5311 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5312 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5313 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5314 @end deftypevr
5315
5316 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5317 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5318 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5319 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5320 return a tristate.
5321
5322 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5323 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5324 don't need to define this macro.
5325 @end defmac
5326
5327 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5328 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5329 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5330 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5331 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5332 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5333 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5334 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5335 @end defmac
5336
5337 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5338 @findex matherr
5339 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5340 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5341 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5342 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5343 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5344 system.
5345
5346 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5347 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5348 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5349 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5350 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5351 @end defmac
5352
5353 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5354 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5355 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5356 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5357 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5358 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5359 @end defmac
5360
5361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5362 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5363 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5364 @end deftypefn
5365
5366 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5367 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5368 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5369 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5370 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5371 the NeXT runtime installed.
5372
5373 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5374 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5375 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5376
5377 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5378 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5379 @end defmac
5380
5381 @node Addressing Modes
5382 @section Addressing Modes
5383 @cindex addressing modes
5384
5385 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5386 This is about addressing modes.
5387
5388 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5389 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5390 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5391 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5392 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5393 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5394 @end defmac
5395
5396 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5397 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5398 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5399 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5400 the size of the memory operand.
5401 @end defmac
5402
5403 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5404 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5405 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5406 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5407 @end defmac
5408
5409 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5410 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5411 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5412 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5413 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5414 constant addresses are supported.
5415 @end defmac
5416
5417 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5418 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5419 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5420 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5421 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5422 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5423 @end defmac
5424
5425 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5426 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5427 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5428 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5429 accept.
5430 @end defmac
5431
5432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5433 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5434 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5435
5436 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5437 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5438 desired by the caller.
5439
5440 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5441 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5442 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5443 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5444 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5445 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5446 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5447 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5448
5449 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5450 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5451 register is required.
5452
5453 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5454 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5455 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5456 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5457 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5458
5459 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5460 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5461 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5462 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5463 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5464
5465 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5466 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5467 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5468 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5469 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5470 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5471 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5472 Format}.
5473
5474 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5475 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5476 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5477 has this syntax:
5478
5479 @example
5480 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5481 @end example
5482
5483 @noindent
5484 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5485 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5486
5487 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5488 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5489 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5490 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5491 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5492
5493 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5494 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5495 @end deftypefn
5496
5497 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5498 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5499 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5500 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5501 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5502 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5503 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5504 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5505 @code{'m'} constraint.
5506 @end defmac
5507
5508 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5509 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5510 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5511 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5512 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5513
5514 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5515 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5516
5517 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5518 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5519 @end defmac
5520
5521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5522 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5523 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5524 address.
5525
5526 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5527 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5528 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5529 @var{x}.
5530
5531 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5532 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5533 should return the new @var{x}.
5534
5535 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5536 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5537 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5538 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5539 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5540 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5541 strategy can generate better code.
5542 @end deftypefn
5543
5544 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5545 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5546 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5547 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5548 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5549 performance reasons.
5550
5551 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5552 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5553 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5554 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5555 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5556 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5557 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5558 be shared.
5559
5560 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5561 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5562 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5563 of reload internals.
5564
5565 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5566 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5567 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5568
5569 @findex push_reload
5570 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5571 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5572 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5573
5574 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5575 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5576 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5577 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5578 @code{push_reload}.
5579
5580 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5581 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5582 the address has become legitimate.
5583
5584 @findex copy_rtx
5585 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5586 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5587 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5588 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5589 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5590 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5591 @end defmac
5592
5593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5594 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5595 space @var{addrspace} can have
5596 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5597 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5598 but not others.
5599
5600 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5601 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5602 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5603 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5604
5605 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5606
5607 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5608 @end deftypefn
5609
5610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5611 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5612 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5613 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5614
5615 The default definition returns true.
5616 @end deftypefn
5617
5618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5619 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5620 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5621 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5622 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5623 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5624 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5625 into their original form.
5626 @end deftypefn
5627
5628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5629 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5630 debug sections.
5631 @end deftypefn
5632
5633 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5634 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5635 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5636 of @var{x}.
5637
5638 The default version of this hook returns false.
5639
5640 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5641 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5642 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5643 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5644 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5645 @end deftypefn
5646
5647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5648 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5649 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5650 of @var{x}.
5651
5652 The default version returns false for all constants.
5653 @end deftypefn
5654
5655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5656 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5657 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5658
5659 The default version returns true for all decls.
5660 @end deftypefn
5661
5662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5663 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5664 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5665 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5666 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5667 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5668 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5669 function are valid.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5673 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5674 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5675 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5676 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5677
5678 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5679 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5680 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5681 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5682 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5683 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5684 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5685 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5686 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5687 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5688 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5689
5690 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5691 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5692 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5693 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5694 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5695 described above.
5696 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5697 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5698 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5699 @end deftypefn
5700
5701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5702 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5703 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5704 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5705 @end deftypefn
5706
5707 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5708 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5709 @end deftypefn
5710
5711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5712 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5713 @end deftypefn
5714
5715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5716 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5717 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5718 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5719 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5720 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5721
5722 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5723 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5724 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5725 @end deftypefn
5726
5727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5728 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5729 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5730 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5731 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5732 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5733 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5734 @end deftypefn
5735
5736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5737 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5738 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5739 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5740 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5741 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5742 @end deftypefn
5743
5744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5745 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5746 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5747 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5748 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5749 @end deftypefn
5750
5751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5752 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5753 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5754 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5755 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5756 @end deftypefn
5757
5758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5759 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5760 @end deftypefn
5761
5762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5763 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5764 @end deftypefn
5765
5766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5767 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5768 @end deftypefn
5769
5770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5771 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5772 @end deftypefn
5773
5774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5775 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5776 @end deftypefn
5777
5778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5779 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5780 @end deftypefn
5781
5782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5783 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5784 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5785 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5786 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5787 loads.
5788 @end deftypefn
5789
5790 @node Anchored Addresses
5791 @section Anchored Addresses
5792 @cindex anchored addresses
5793 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5794
5795 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5796 For example, if we have:
5797
5798 @smallexample
5799 static int a, b, c;
5800 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5801 @end smallexample
5802
5803 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5804 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5805 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5806 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5807 be something like:
5808
5809 @smallexample
5810 int foo (void)
5811 @{
5812 register int *xr = &x;
5813 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5814 @}
5815 @end smallexample
5816
5817 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5818 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5819
5820 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5821 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5822 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5823 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5824
5825 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5826 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5827 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5828 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5829 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5830 @end deftypevr
5831
5832 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5833 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5834 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5835 value is 0.
5836 @end deftypevr
5837
5838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5839 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5840 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5841 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5842 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5843
5844 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5845 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5846 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5847 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5848 @end deftypefn
5849
5850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5851 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5852 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5853 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5854
5855 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5856 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5857 or target-specific sections.
5858 @end deftypefn
5859
5860 @node Condition Code
5861 @section Condition Code Status
5862 @cindex condition code status
5863
5864 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5865 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5866
5867 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5868 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5869 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5870 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5871 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5872 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5873 most RISC machines.
5874
5875 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5876 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5877 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5878 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5879 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5880 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5881 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5882 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5883
5884 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5885 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5886 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5887 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5888 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5889 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5890 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5891
5892 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5893 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5894 interested in most macros in this section.
5895
5896 @menu
5897 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5898 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5899 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5900 @end menu
5901
5902 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5903 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5904 @findex cc0
5905
5906 @findex cc_status
5907 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5908 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5909 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5910 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5911 currently based, and several standard flags.
5912
5913 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5914 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5915 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5916
5917 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5918 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5919 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5920
5921 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5922 @end defmac
5923
5924 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5925 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5926 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5927 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5928 define this macro to initialize it.
5929
5930 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5931 @end defmac
5932
5933 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5934 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5935 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5936 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5937 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5938 set @code{(cc0)}.
5939
5940 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5941
5942 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5943 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5944 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5945 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5946 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5947 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5948 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5949 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5950 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5951 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5952 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5953 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5954 condition code value.
5955
5956 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5957 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5958 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5959 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5960 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5961 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5962 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5963
5964 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5965 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5966 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5967 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5968 @end defmac
5969
5970 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5971 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5972 @findex CCmode
5973 @findex MODE_CC
5974
5975 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5976 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5977 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5978 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5979 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5980 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5981 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5982 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5983 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5984 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5985 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5986
5987 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5988 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5989 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5990 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5991 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5992 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5993 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 (define_insn ""
5997 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5998 (compare:CC_NOOV
5999 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6000 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6001 (const_int 0)))]
6002 ""
6003 "@dots{}")
6004 @end smallexample
6005
6006 @noindent
6007 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6008 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6009
6010 @smallexample
6011 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6012 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6013 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6014 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6015 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6016 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6017 @end smallexample
6018
6019 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6020 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6021 this section.
6022
6023 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6024 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6025 @end defmac
6026
6027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6028 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6029 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6030 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6031 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6032
6033 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6034 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6035 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6036 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6037 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6038 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6039 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6040
6041 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6042 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6043 @file{md} file.
6044
6045 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6046 comparison code or operands.
6047 @end deftypefn
6048
6049 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6050 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6051 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6052 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6053 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6054
6055 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6056 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6057 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6058 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6059
6060 @smallexample
6061 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6062 @end smallexample
6063 @end defmac
6064
6065 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6066 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6067 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6068 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6069 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6070 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6071 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6072 like:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6076 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6077 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6078 @end smallexample
6079 @end defmac
6080
6081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6082 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6083 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6084 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6085 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6086 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6087 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6088 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6089 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6090 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6091 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6092
6093 The default version of this hook returns false.
6094 @end deftypefn
6095
6096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6097 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6098 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6099 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6100 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6101 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6102 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6103
6104 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6105 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6106 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6107 @end deftypefn
6108
6109 @node Cond Exec Macros
6110 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6111 @findex conditional execution
6112 @findex predication
6113
6114 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6115 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6116 represent conditional branches.
6117
6118 @node Costs
6119 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6120 @cindex costs of instructions
6121 @cindex relative costs
6122 @cindex speed of instructions
6123
6124 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6125 on the target machine.
6126
6127 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6128 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6129 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6130 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6131 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6132 that.
6133
6134 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6135 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6136 registers if they are not general registers.
6137
6138 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6139 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6140 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6141 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6142 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6143 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6144
6145 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6146 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6147 @end defmac
6148
6149 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6150 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6151 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6152 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6153 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6154 that.
6155
6156 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6157 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6158 registers if they are not general registers.
6159
6160 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6161 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6162 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6163 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6164 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6165 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6166
6167 The default version of this function returns 2.
6168 @end deftypefn
6169
6170 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6171 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6172 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6173 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6174 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6175 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6176 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6177
6178 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6179 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6180 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6181 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6182 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6183 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6184
6185 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6186 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6187 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6188 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6189 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6190 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6191 are the same as to this macro.
6192
6193 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6194 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6195 @end defmac
6196
6197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6198 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6199 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6200 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6201 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6202 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6203 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6204
6205 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6206 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6207 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6208 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6209 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6210 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6211
6212 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6213 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6214 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6215 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6216 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6217 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6218 are the same as to this target hook.
6219 @end deftypefn
6220
6221 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6222 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6223 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6224 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6225 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6226 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6227 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6228 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6229 @end defmac
6230
6231 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6232 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6233 ordinarily expect.
6234
6235 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6236 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6237 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6238 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6239 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6240 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6241
6242 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6243 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6244 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6245 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6246 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6247 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6248 @end defmac
6249
6250 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6251 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6252 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6253 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6254 handler.
6255
6256 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6257 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6258 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6259 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6260 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6261
6262 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6263 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6264 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6265 @end defmac
6266
6267 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6268 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6269 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6270 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6271 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6272
6273 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6274 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6275 the number of such sequences.
6276
6277 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6278 optimized for speed rather than size.
6279
6280 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6281 @end defmac
6282
6283 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6284 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6285 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6286 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6287 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6288 @end defmac
6289
6290 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6291 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6292 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6293 @end defmac
6294
6295 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6296 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6297 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6298 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6299 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6300
6301 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6302 optimized for speed rather than size.
6303
6304 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6305 @end defmac
6306
6307 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6308 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6309 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6310 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6311 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6312 @end defmac
6313
6314 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6315 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6316 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6317 a block set insn or a library call.
6318 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6319 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6320
6321 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6322 optimized for speed rather than size.
6323
6324 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6325 @end defmac
6326
6327 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6328 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6329 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6330 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6331 storing values other than constant zero.
6332 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6333 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6334 @end defmac
6335
6336 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6337 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6338 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6339 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6340 called with a constant source string.
6341 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6342 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6343 @end defmac
6344
6345 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6346 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6347 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6348 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6349 @end defmac
6350
6351 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6352 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6353 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6354 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6355 @end defmac
6356
6357 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6358 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6359 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6360 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6361 @end defmac
6362
6363 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6364 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6365 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6366 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6367 @end defmac
6368
6369 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6370 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6371 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6372 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6373 @end defmac
6374
6375 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6376 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6377 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6378 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6379 @end defmac
6380
6381 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6382 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6383 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6384 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6385 @end defmac
6386
6387 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6388 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6389 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6390 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6391 @end defmac
6392
6393 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6394 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6395 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6396 @end defmac
6397
6398 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6399 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6400 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6401 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6402 @end defmac
6403
6404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6405 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6406
6407 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6408 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6409 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6410 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6411 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6412 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6413 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6414
6415 @var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6416 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6417
6418 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6419 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6420 instructions.
6421
6422 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6423 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6424 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6425 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6426 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6427
6428 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6429 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6430 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6431
6432 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6433 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6434 @end deftypefn
6435
6436 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6437 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6438 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6439 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6440
6441 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6442 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6443 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6444 all addresses will have equal costs.
6445
6446 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6447 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6448 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6449
6450 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6451 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6452 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6453 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6454 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6455 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6456 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6457 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6458
6459 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6460
6461 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6462 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6463 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6464 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6465 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6466 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6467 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6468 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6469 @end deftypefn
6470
6471 @node Scheduling
6472 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6473
6474 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6475 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6476 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6477 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6478
6479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6480 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6481 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6482 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6483 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6484 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6485 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6486 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6487 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6488 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6489 @end deftypefn
6490
6491 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6492 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6493 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6494 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6495 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6496 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6497 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6498 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6499 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6500 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6501 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6502 was scheduled.
6503 @end deftypefn
6504
6505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6506 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6507 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6508 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6509 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6510 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6511 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6512 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6513 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6514 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6515 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6516 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6517 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6518 @end deftypefn
6519
6520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6521 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6522 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6523 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6524 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6525 scheduling priorities of insns.
6526 @end deftypefn
6527
6528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6529 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6530 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6531 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6532 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6533 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6534 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6535 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6536 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6537 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6538 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6539 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6540 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6541 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6542 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6543 @end deftypefn
6544
6545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6546 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6547 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6548 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6549 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6550 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6551 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6552 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6553 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6554 @end deftypefn
6555
6556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6557 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6558 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6559 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6560 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6561 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6562 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6563 calculated.
6564 @end deftypefn
6565
6566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6567 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6568 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6569 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6570 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6571 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6572 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6573 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6574 @end deftypefn
6575
6576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6577 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6578 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6579 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6580 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6581 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6582 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6583 @end deftypefn
6584
6585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6586 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6587 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6588 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6589 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6590 @end deftypefn
6591
6592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6593 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6594 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6595 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6596 @end deftypefn
6597
6598 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6599 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6600 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6601 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6602 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6603 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6604 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6605 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6606 @end deftypefn
6607
6608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6609 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6610 @end deftypefn
6611
6612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6613 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6614 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6615 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6616 @end deftypefn
6617
6618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6619 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6620 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6621 @end deftypefn
6622
6623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6624 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6625 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6626 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6627 state on a single insn is not enough.
6628 @end deftypefn
6629
6630 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6631 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6632 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6633 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6634 state on a single insn is not enough.
6635 @end deftypefn
6636
6637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6638 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6639 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6640 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6641 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6642 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6643 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6644 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6645 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6646 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6647 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6648
6649 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6650 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6651 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6652 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6653 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6654 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6655 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6656 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6657 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6658
6659 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6660 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6661 schedules to choose the best one.
6662
6663 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6664 @end deftypefn
6665
6666 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6667
6668 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6669 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6670 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6671 be issued.
6672
6673 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6674 @end deftypefn
6675
6676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6677 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6678 scheduling.
6679 @end deftypefn
6680
6681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6682 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6683 @end deftypefn
6684
6685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6686 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6687 an instruction.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6691 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6692 round of multipass scheduling.
6693 @end deftypefn
6694
6695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6696 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6697 @end deftypefn
6698
6699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6700 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6701 @end deftypefn
6702
6703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6704 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6705 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6706 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6707 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6708 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6709 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6710 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6711 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6712 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6713 and the current processor cycle.
6714 @end deftypefn
6715
6716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6717 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6718 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6719 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6720 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6721 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6722 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6723 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6724 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6725 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6726 and @code{false} otherwise.
6727
6728 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6729 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6730 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6731 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6732 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6733 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6734 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6735 @end deftypefn
6736
6737 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6738 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6739 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6740 per instruction data structures.
6741 @end deftypefn
6742
6743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6744 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6745 @end deftypefn
6746
6747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6748 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6749 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6750 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6751 @end deftypefn
6752
6753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6754 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6755 @end deftypefn
6756
6757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6758 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6759 @end deftypefn
6760
6761 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6762 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6763 @end deftypefn
6764
6765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6766 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6767 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6768 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6769 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6770 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6771 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6772 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6773 the generated speculative pattern.
6774 @end deftypefn
6775
6776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6777 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6778 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6779 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6780 @end deftypefn
6781
6782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6783 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6784 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6785 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6786 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6787 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6788 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6789 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6790 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6791 @end deftypefn
6792
6793 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6794 This hook is used as a workaround for
6795 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6796 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6797 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6798 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6799 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6800 For non-speculative instructions,
6801 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6802 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6803 is nearly full.
6804 @end deftypefn
6805
6806 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6807 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6808 enabled/used.
6809 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6810 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6811 @end deftypefn
6812
6813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6814 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6815 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6816 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6817 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6818 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6819 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6820 @end deftypefn
6821
6822 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6823 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6824 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6825 @end deftypefn
6826
6827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6828 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6829 in its second parameter.
6830 @end deftypefn
6831
6832 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6833 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6834 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6835 also the latencies of operations.
6836 @end deftypevr
6837
6838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6839 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6840 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6841 @end deftypefn
6842
6843 @node Sections
6844 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6845 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6846 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6847
6848 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6849 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6850 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6851 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6852 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6853 of sections.
6854
6855 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6856 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6857 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6858 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6859 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6860 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6861 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6862
6863 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6864 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6865 to be string literals.
6866
6867 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6868 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6869 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6870 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6871
6872 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6873 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6874 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6875 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6876 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6877 reuse @code{text_section}.
6878
6879 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6880 if the target does not provide them.
6881
6882 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6883 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6884 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6885 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6886 @end defmac
6887
6888 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6889 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6890 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6891 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6892 @end defmac
6893
6894 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6895 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6896 executed functions in the program.
6897 @end defmac
6898
6899 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6900 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6901 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6902 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6903 @end defmac
6904
6905 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908 initialized, writable small data.
6909 @end defmac
6910
6911 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6912 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6913 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6914 data.
6915 @end defmac
6916
6917 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6918 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6919 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6920 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6921 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6922 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6923 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6924 used.
6925 @end defmac
6926
6927 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6928 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6929 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6930 uninitialized, writable small data.
6931 @end defmac
6932
6933 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6934 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6935 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6936 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6937 @end defmac
6938
6939 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6940 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6941 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6942 default is @code{'T'}.
6943 @end defmac
6944
6945 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6946 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6947 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6948 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6949 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6950 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6951 @end defmac
6952
6953 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6954 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6955 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6956 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6957 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6958 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6959 @end defmac
6960
6961 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6962 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6963 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6964 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6965 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6966 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6967 @end defmac
6968
6969 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6970 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6971 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6972 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6973 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6974 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6975 @end defmac
6976
6977 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6978 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6979 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6980 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6981 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6982 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6983 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6984 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6985 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6986 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6987 @end defmac
6988
6989 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6990 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6991 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6992 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6993 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6994 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6995 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6996 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6997 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6998 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6999 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7000 @end defmac
7001
7002 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7003 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7004 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7005 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7006 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7007 @end defmac
7008
7009 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7010 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7011 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7012 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7013 readonly data section is used.
7014
7015 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7016 @end defmac
7017
7018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7019 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7020 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7021 of its own that you need to create.
7022
7023 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7024 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7025 described below.
7026 @end deftypefn
7027
7028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7029 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7030 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7031 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7032 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7033
7034 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7035 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7036 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7037 in read-only sections even in executables.
7038 @end deftypefn
7039
7040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7041 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7042 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7043 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7044 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7045 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7046 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7047
7048 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7049 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7050
7051 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7052 @end deftypefn
7053
7054 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7055 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7056 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7057
7058 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7059 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7060 it is unlikely to be called.
7061 @end defmac
7062
7063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7064 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7065 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7066 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7067 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7068
7069 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7070 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7071 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7072 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7073 @end deftypefn
7074
7075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7076 Return the readonly data section associated with
7077 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7078 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7079 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7080 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7081 otherwise.
7082 @end deftypefn
7083
7084 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7085 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7086 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7087 the string if a different section name should be used.
7088 @end deftypevr
7089
7090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7091 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7092 @end deftypefn
7093
7094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7095 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7096 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7097 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7098 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7099 in bits.
7100
7101 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7102 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7103 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7104 @end deftypefn
7105
7106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7107 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7108 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7109 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7110 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7111 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7112 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7113 returns the @var{id} provided.
7114 @end deftypefn
7115
7116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7117 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7118 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7119 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7120
7121 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7122 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7123 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7124 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7125 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7126
7127 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7128 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7129 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7130 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7131 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7132 leave it alone.)
7133
7134 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7135 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7136 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7137 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7138 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7139 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7140
7141 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7142 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7143 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7144 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7145 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7146 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7147
7148 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7149 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7150 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7151 before overriding it.
7152 @end deftypefn
7153
7154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7155 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7156 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7157 may have added.
7158 @end deftypefn
7159
7160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7161 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7162 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7163 @end deftypefn
7164
7165 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7166 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7167 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7168 @end deftypevr
7169
7170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7171 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7172
7173 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7174 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7175 @end deftypefn
7176
7177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7178 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7179 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7180 or executable image).
7181
7182 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7183 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7184 currently supported object file formats.
7185 @end deftypefn
7186
7187 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7188 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7189 The default value is false.
7190 @end deftypevr
7191
7192
7193 @node PIC
7194 @section Position Independent Code
7195 @cindex position independent code
7196 @cindex PIC
7197
7198 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7199 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7200 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7201 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7202 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7203 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7204 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7205 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7206 relative addresses.
7207 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7208 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7209
7210 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7211 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7212 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7213 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7214 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7215 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7216 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7217 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7218 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7219 @end defmac
7220
7221 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7222 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7223 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7224 the default is zero. Do not define
7225 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7226 @end defmac
7227
7228 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7229 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7230 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7231 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7232 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7233 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7234 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7235 position independent code.
7236 @end defmac
7237
7238 @node Assembler Format
7239 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7240
7241 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7242 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7243 instructions do.
7244
7245 @menu
7246 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7247 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7248 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7249 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7250 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7251 and termination routines.
7252 * Macros for Initialization::
7253 Specific macros that control the handling of
7254 initialization and termination routines.
7255 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7256 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7257 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7258 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7259 @end menu
7260
7261 @node File Framework
7262 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7263 @cindex assembler format
7264 @cindex output of assembler code
7265
7266 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7267 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7268
7269 @findex default_file_start
7270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7271 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7272 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7273 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7274 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7275 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7276 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7277 @end deftypefn
7278
7279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7280 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7281 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7282 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7283 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7284 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7285 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7286 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7287
7288 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7289 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7290 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7291 @end deftypevr
7292
7293 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7294 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7295 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7296 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7297 this to be done. The default is false.
7298 @end deftypevr
7299
7300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7301 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7302 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7303 @end deftypefn
7304
7305 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7306 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7307 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7308 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7309 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7310 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7311 this function.
7312 @end deftypefun
7313
7314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7315 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7316 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7317 nothing.
7318 @end deftypefn
7319
7320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7321 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7322 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7323 nothing.
7324 @end deftypefn
7325
7326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7327 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7328 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7329 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7330 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7331 nothing.
7332 @end deftypefn
7333
7334 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7335 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7336 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7337 the end of the line.
7338 @end defmac
7339
7340 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7341 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7342 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7343 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7344 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7345 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7346 @end defmac
7347
7348 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7349 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7350 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7351 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7352 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7353 @end defmac
7354
7355 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7356 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7357 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7358 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7359
7360 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7361 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7362 @end defmac
7363
7364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7365 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7366
7367 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7368 @end deftypefn
7369
7370 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7371 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7372 @end deftypefn
7373
7374 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7375 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7376 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7377 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7378 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7379 of the filename using this macro.
7380 @end defmac
7381
7382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7383 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7384 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7385 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7386 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7387 this section is associated.
7388 @end deftypefn
7389
7390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7391 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7392 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7393 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7394 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7395 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7396 (from static destructors).
7397 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7398 @end deftypefn
7399
7400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7401 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7402 @end deftypefn
7403
7404 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7405 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7406 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7407 @end deftypevr
7408
7409 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7410 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7411 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7412 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7413 This is true on most ELF targets.
7414 @end deftypevr
7415
7416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7417 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7418 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7419 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7420 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7421
7422 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7423 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7424 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7425 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7426 @end deftypefn
7427
7428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7429 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7430 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7431 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7432 It can take the following values:
7433
7434 @table @gcctabopt
7435 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7436 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7437
7438 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7439 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7440 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7441 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7442 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7443 various different individual optimization passes.
7444
7445 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7446 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7447 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7448 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7449 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7450 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7451 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7452 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7453 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7454 switches.
7455
7456 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7457 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7458
7459 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7460 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7464 supported in the future.
7465
7466 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7467 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7468 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7469 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7470 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7471 hook.
7472 @end deftypefn
7473
7474 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7475 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7476 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7477 hook.
7478 @end deftypevr
7479
7480 @need 2000
7481 @node Data Output
7482 @subsection Output of Data
7483
7484
7485 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7486 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7487 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7488 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7489 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7490 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7491 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7492 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7493 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7494 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7495 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7496 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7497 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7498 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7499
7500 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7501 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7502 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7503 @end deftypevr
7504
7505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7506 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7507 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7508 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7509 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7510 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7511 split the object into smaller parts.
7512
7513 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7514 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7515 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7516 @end deftypefn
7517
7518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7519 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7520 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7521 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7522 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7523
7524 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7525 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7526 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7527 return @code{true}.
7528 @end deftypefn
7529
7530 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7531 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7532 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7533 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7534 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7535
7536 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7537 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7538 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7539 @end defmac
7540
7541 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7542 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7543 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7544 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7545 @end defmac
7546
7547 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7548 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7549 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7550 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7551 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7552 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7553 pool before the function.
7554 @end defmac
7555
7556 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7557 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7558 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7559 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7560 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7561 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7562 immediately after this call.
7563
7564 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7565 not be defined.
7566 @end defmac
7567
7568 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7569 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7570 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7571 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7572
7573 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7574 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7575 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7576 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7577 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7578 alignment.
7579
7580 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7581 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7582 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7583 Here is how to do this:
7584
7585 @smallexample
7586 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7587 @end smallexample
7588
7589 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7590 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7591 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7592
7593 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7594 @end defmac
7595
7596 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7597 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7598 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7599 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7600 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7601 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7602
7603 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7604 define this macro.
7605 @end defmac
7606
7607 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7608 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7609 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7610 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7611 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7612
7613 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7614 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7615 @end defmac
7616
7617 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7618 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7619 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7620 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7621 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7622 @end deftypevr
7623
7624 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7625 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7626
7627 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7628 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7629 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7630 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7631 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7632 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7633 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7634 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7635 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7636 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7637 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7638 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7639 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7640 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7641 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7642 on the host machine.
7643
7644 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7645 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7646 machine's memory.
7647 @end defmac
7648
7649 @node Uninitialized Data
7650 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7651
7652 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7653 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7654
7655 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7656 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7657 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7658 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7659 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7660 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7661 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7662 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7663 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7664 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7665 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7666 an ordinary undefined external.
7667
7668 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7669 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7670 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7671
7672 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7673 common global variables are output.
7674 @end defmac
7675
7676 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7677 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7678 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7679 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7680 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7681 as the number of bits.
7682 @end defmac
7683
7684 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7685 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7686 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7687 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7688 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7689 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7690 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7691 @end defmac
7692
7693 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7694 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7695 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7696 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7697 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7698
7699 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7700 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7701 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7702 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7703 the name, and a newline.
7704
7705 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7706 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7707 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7708 You do not need to do both.
7709
7710 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7711 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7712 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7713 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7714 common in order to save space in the object file.
7715 @end defmac
7716
7717 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7718 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7719 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7720 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7721 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7722
7723 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7724 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7725 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7726
7727 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7728 static variables are output.
7729 @end defmac
7730
7731 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7732 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7733 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7734 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7735 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7736 as the number of bits.
7737 @end defmac
7738
7739 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7740 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7741 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7742 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7743 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7744 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7745 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7746 @end defmac
7747
7748 @node Label Output
7749 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7750
7751 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7752 This is about outputting labels.
7753
7754 @findex assemble_name
7755 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7756 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7757 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7758 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7759 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7760 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7761 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7762 @end defmac
7763
7764 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7765 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7766 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7767 a function.
7768 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7769 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7770 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7771 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7772
7773 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7774 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7775 @end defmac
7776
7777 @findex assemble_name_raw
7778 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7779 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7780 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7781 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7782 that it is more efficient.
7783 @end defmac
7784
7785 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7786 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7787 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7788 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7789 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7790
7791 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7792 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7793 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7794 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7795 define this macro.
7796 @end defmac
7797
7798 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7799 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7800 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7801 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7802 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7803 provided.
7804 @end defmac
7805
7806 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7807 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7808 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7809 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7810 address.
7811
7812 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7813 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7814 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7815 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7816 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7817 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7821 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7822 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7823 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7824 @samp{.} is used instead.
7825 @end defmac
7826
7827 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7828 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7829 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7830 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7831 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7832 @end defmac
7833
7834 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7835 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7836 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7837 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7838 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7839
7840 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7841 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7842 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7843 types at all, do not define this macro.
7844 @end defmac
7845
7846 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7847 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7848 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7849 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7850 the default is not to define this macro.
7851
7852 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7853 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7854 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7855 types at all, do not define this macro.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7859 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7860 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7861 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7862 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7863 you should not count on this.
7864
7865 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7866 definition of this macro is provided.
7867 @end defmac
7868
7869 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7870 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7871 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7872 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7873 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7874 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7875 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7876
7877 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7878 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7879
7880 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7881 of this macro.
7882 @end defmac
7883
7884 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7885 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7886 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7887 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7888 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7889 representing the function.
7890
7891 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7892
7893 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7894 of this macro.
7895 @end defmac
7896
7897 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7898 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7899 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7900 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7901 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7902 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7903
7904 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7905 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7906
7907 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7908 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7909 @end defmac
7910
7911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7912 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7913 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7914 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7915 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7916 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7917 will be an internal label.
7918
7919 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7920 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7921
7922 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7923 @end deftypefn
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7928 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7929
7930 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7931 nothing.
7932 @end defmac
7933
7934 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7935 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7936 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7937 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7938 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7939 something about the size of the object.
7940
7941 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7942 nothing.
7943
7944 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7945 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7946 @end defmac
7947
7948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7949 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7950 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7951 that is, available for reference from other files.
7952
7953 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7954 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7955 @end deftypefn
7956
7957 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7958 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7959 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7960 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7961
7962 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7963 @end deftypefn
7964
7965 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7966 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7967 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7968 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7969 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7970 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7971 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7972 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7973
7974 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7975 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7976 macro.
7977 @end defmac
7978
7979 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7980 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7981 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7982 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7983 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7984 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7985 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7986 to make @var{name} weak.
7987 @end defmac
7988
7989 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7990 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7991 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7992 declaration of @code{name}.
7993 @end defmac
7994
7995 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7996 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7997 supports weak symbols.
7998
7999 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8000 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8001 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8002 @end defmac
8003
8004 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8005 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8006
8007 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8008 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8009 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8010 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8011 @end defmac
8012
8013 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8014 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8015 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8016 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8017 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8018 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8019 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8020 @end defmac
8021
8022 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8023 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8024 semantics.
8025
8026 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8027 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8028 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8029 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8030 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8031 be emitted as one-only.
8032 @end defmac
8033
8034 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8035 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8036 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8037 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8038 @end deftypefn
8039
8040 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8041 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8042 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8043 The default is @code{0}.
8044
8045 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8046 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8047 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8048 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8049 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8050 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8051 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8052
8053 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8054 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8055 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8056 table of contents.
8057 @end defmac
8058
8059 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8060 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8061 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8062 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8063 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8064 declaration.
8065
8066 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8067 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8068 @end defmac
8069
8070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8071 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8072 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8073 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8074 @end deftypefn
8075
8076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8077 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8078 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8079 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8080 @end deftypefn
8081
8082 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8083 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8084 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8085 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8086 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8087 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8088 @end defmac
8089
8090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8091 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8092 @end deftypefn
8093
8094 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8095 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8096 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8097 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8098 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8099 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8100 @end defmac
8101
8102 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8103 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8104 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8105 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8106 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8107 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8108 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8109 being taken.
8110 @end defmac
8111
8112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8113 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8114 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8115
8116 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8117 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8118 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8119
8120 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8121 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8122 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8123 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8124 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8125
8126 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8127 @end deftypefn
8128
8129 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8130 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8131 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8132 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8133 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8134 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8135 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8136 bundles.
8137
8138 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8139 used.
8140 @end defmac
8141
8142 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8143 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8144 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8145
8146 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8147 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8148 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8149
8150 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8151 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8152 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8153 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8154 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8155 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8156 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8157 @end defmac
8158
8159 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8160 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8161 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8162 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8163 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8164
8165 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8166 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8167 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8168 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8169 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8170 internal static variables in different scopes.
8171
8172 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8173 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8174 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8175 between the name and the number will suffice.
8176
8177 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8178 which is correct for most systems.
8179 @end defmac
8180
8181 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8182 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8183 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8184
8185 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8186 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8187 correct for most systems.
8188 @end defmac
8189
8190 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8191 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8192 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8193 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8194 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8195 the tree nodes are available.
8196
8197 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8198 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8199 correct for most systems.
8200 @end defmac
8201
8202 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8203 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8204 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8205 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8206 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8207 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8208 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8209 @end defmac
8210
8211 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8212 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8213 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8214 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8215 an undefined weak symbol.
8216
8217 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8218 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8219 @end defmac
8220
8221 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8222 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8223 Objective-C methods.
8224
8225 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8226 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8227 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8228 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8229
8230 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8231 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8232 systems define other ways of computing names.
8233
8234 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8235 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8236 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8237 50 characters extra.
8238
8239 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8240 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8241 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8242 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8243
8244 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8245 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8246 @end defmac
8247
8248 @node Initialization
8249 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8250 @cindex initialization routines
8251 @cindex termination routines
8252 @cindex constructors, output of
8253 @cindex destructors, output of
8254
8255 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8256 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8257 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8258 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8259 @code{main} is called.
8260
8261 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8262 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8263 terminates.
8264
8265 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8266 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8267 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8268 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8269
8270 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8271 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8272 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8273
8274 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8275 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8276 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8277 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8278 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8279
8280 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8281 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8282 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8283 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8284 pointer containing zero.
8285
8286 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8287 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8288 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8289 list; destructors in forward order.
8290
8291 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8292 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8293 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8294 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8295 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8296 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8297 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8298 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8299
8300 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8301 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8302 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8303 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8304 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8305
8306 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8307 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8308 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8309 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8310 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8311
8312 @smallexample
8313 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8314 @end smallexample
8315
8316 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8317 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8318 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8319 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8320 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8321
8322 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8323 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8324 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8325 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8326 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8327 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8328
8329 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8330 macro properly.
8331
8332 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8333 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8334 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8335 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8336 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8337 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8338
8339 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8340 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8341 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8342 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8343 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8344 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8345 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8346 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8347 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8348 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8349 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8350 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8351 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8352 the initialization process.
8353
8354 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8355 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8356 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8357 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8358 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8359 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8360 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8361 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8362 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8363 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8364 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8365
8366 @ifinfo
8367 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8368 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8369 @end ifinfo
8370
8371 @node Macros for Initialization
8372 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8373
8374 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8375 and termination functions:
8376
8377 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8378 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8379 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8380 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8381 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8382 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8383 run the initialization functions.
8384 @end defmac
8385
8386 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8387 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8388 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8389 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8390 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8391 @end defmac
8392
8393 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8394 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8395 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8396 @end defmac
8397
8398 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8399 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8400 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8401 @end defmac
8402
8403 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8404 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8405 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8406 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8407 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8408 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8409
8410 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8411 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8412 exception tables embedded in the code.
8413 @end defmac
8414
8415 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8416 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8417 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8418 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8419 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8420 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8421 @end defmac
8422
8423 @defmac INVOKE__main
8424 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8425 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8426 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8427 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8428 @end defmac
8429
8430 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8431 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8432 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8433 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8434 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8435 @end defmac
8436
8437 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8438 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8439 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8440 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8441 @end deftypevr
8442
8443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8444 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8445 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8446
8447 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8448 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8449 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8450 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8451
8452 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8453 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8454 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8455 is not defined.
8456 @end deftypefn
8457
8458 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8459 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8460 functions rather than initialization functions.
8461 @end deftypefn
8462
8463 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8464 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8465
8466 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8467 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8468 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8469
8470 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8471 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8472
8473 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8474 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8475 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8476 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8477
8478 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8479 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8480 @end defmac
8481
8482 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8483 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8484 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8485 @command{nm}.
8486 @end defmac
8487
8488 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8489 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8490 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8491 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8492 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8493 produces.
8494 @end defmac
8495
8496 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8497 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8498 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8499 termination functions in shared libraries:
8500
8501 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8502 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8503 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8504 @end defmac
8505
8506 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8507 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8508 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8509 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8510 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8511 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8512 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8513 @end defmac
8514
8515 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8516 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8517 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8518 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8519 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8520 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8521 @end defmac
8522
8523 @node Instruction Output
8524 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8525
8526 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8527 This describes assembler instruction output.
8528
8529 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8530 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8531 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8532 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8533 @end defmac
8534
8535 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8536 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8537 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8538 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8539 to registers using alternate names.
8540 @end defmac
8541
8542 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8543 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8544 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8545 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8546 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8547 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8548 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8549 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8550
8551 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8552 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8553 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8554 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8555 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8556 @end defmac
8557
8558 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8559 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8560 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8561
8562 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8563 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8564 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8565 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8566 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8567 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8568 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8569 so that it will not be output twice.
8570
8571 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8572 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8573 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8574 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8575 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8576
8577 @findex recog_data.operand
8578 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8579 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8580
8581 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8582 in the usual way.
8583 @end defmac
8584
8585 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8586 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8587 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8588 they will be output differently.
8589
8590 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8591 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8592 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8593 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8594 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8595 by changing the contents of the vector.
8596
8597 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8598 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8599 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8600 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8601 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8602 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8603
8604 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8605 @end defmac
8606
8607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8608 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8609 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8610 if necessary.
8611
8612 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8613 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8614 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8615 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8616 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8617 by checking the contents of the vector.
8618 @end deftypefn
8619
8620 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8621 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8622 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8623 RTL expression.
8624
8625 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8626 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8627 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8628 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8629 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8630 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8631 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8632
8633 @findex reg_names
8634 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8635 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8636 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8637 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8638
8639 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8640 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8641 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8642 @var{code}.
8643 @end defmac
8644
8645 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8646 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8647 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8648 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8649 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8650 in this way.
8651 @end defmac
8652
8653 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8654 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8655 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8656 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8657
8658 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8659 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8660 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8661 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8662 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8663 Format}.
8664 @end defmac
8665
8666 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8667 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8668 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8669 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8670 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8671 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8672 or whatever.
8673
8674 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8675 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8676 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8677 @end defmac
8678
8679 @findex final_sequence
8680 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8681 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8682 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8683 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8684 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8685 being output.
8686
8687 @findex asm_fprintf
8688 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8689 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8690 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8691 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8692 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8693 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8694 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8695 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8696 files can define these macros differently.
8697 @end defmac
8698
8699 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8700 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8701 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8702 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8703 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8704 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8705 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8706 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8707 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8708 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8709 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8710 @end defmac
8711
8712 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8713 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8714 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8715 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8716 first variant.
8717
8718 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8719 @smallexample
8720 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8721 @end smallexample
8722 @noindent
8723 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8724 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8725 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8726 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8727 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8728 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8729 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8730 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8731 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
8732
8733 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8734 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8735 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8736
8737 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8738 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8739 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8740 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8741 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8742 opcodes or operand order.
8743 @end defmac
8744
8745 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8746 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8747 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8748 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8749 profiling.
8750 @end defmac
8751
8752 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8753 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8754 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8755 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8756 profiling.
8757 @end defmac
8758
8759 @node Dispatch Tables
8760 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8761
8762 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8763 This concerns dispatch tables.
8764
8765 @cindex dispatch table
8766 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8767 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8768 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8769 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8770 definitions of these labels are output using
8771 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8772 way here. For example,
8773
8774 @smallexample
8775 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8776 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8777 @end smallexample
8778
8779 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8780 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8781 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8782 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8783 mode and flags can be read.
8784 @end defmac
8785
8786 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8787 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8788 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8789
8790 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8791 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8792 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8793 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8794 For example,
8795
8796 @smallexample
8797 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8798 @end smallexample
8799 @end defmac
8800
8801 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8802 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8803 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8804 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8805 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
8806 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8807
8808 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8809 for the table.
8810
8811 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8812 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8813 @end defmac
8814
8815 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8816 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8817 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8818 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8819 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8820 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8821 of the preceding label.
8822
8823 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8824 the jump-table.
8825 @end defmac
8826
8827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8828 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8829 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8830 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8831 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8832 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8833 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8834 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8835
8836 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8837 @end deftypefn
8838
8839 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8840 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8841 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8842 to be broken up according to function.
8843
8844 The default is that no label is emitted.
8845 @end deftypefn
8846
8847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8848 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8849 @end deftypefn
8850
8851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8852 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8853 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8854 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8855 @end deftypefn
8856
8857 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8858 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8859 @end deftypevr
8860
8861 @node Exception Region Output
8862 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8863
8864 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8865
8866 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8867 region.
8868
8869 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8870 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8871 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8872 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8873 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8874
8875 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8876 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8877 @end defmac
8878
8879 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8880 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8881 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8882 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8883 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8884
8885 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8886 also defined.
8887 @end defmac
8888
8889 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8890 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8891 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8892 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8893 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8894 @end defmac
8895
8896 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8897 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8898 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8899 @end defmac
8900
8901 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8902 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8903 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8904 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8905 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8906 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8907 @end defmac
8908
8909 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8910 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8911 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8912 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8913 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8914 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8915 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8916
8917 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8918 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8919 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8920
8921 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8922 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8923 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8924 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8925 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8926 depending on this setting.
8927
8928 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8929 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8930 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8931 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8932 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8933 @end deftypefn
8934
8935 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8936 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8937 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8938 command-line option processing.
8939 @end deftypevr
8940
8941 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8942 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8943 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8944 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8945 @end defmac
8946
8947 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8948 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8949 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8950 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8951 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8952 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8953 @end defmac
8954
8955 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8956 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8957 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8958 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8959 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8960 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8961 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8962 @end defmac
8963
8964 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8965 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8966 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8967 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8968 true otherwise.
8969 @end deftypevr
8970
8971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8972 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8973 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8974 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8975 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8976 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8977 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8978 @end deftypefn
8979
8980 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8981 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8982 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8983 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8984 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8985 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8986 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8987 @end deftypefn
8988
8989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8990 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8991 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8992 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8993 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8994 @end deftypefn
8995
8996 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8997 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8998 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8999 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9000 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9001 @end deftypevr
9002
9003 @node Alignment Output
9004 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9005
9006 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9007 This describes commands for alignment.
9008
9009 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9010 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9011 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9012
9013 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9014 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9015 define the macro.
9016
9017 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9018 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9019 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9020 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9021 @end defmac
9022
9023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9024 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9025 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9026 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9027 @end deftypefn
9028
9029 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9030 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9031 a @code{BARRIER}.
9032
9033 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9034 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9035 define the macro.
9036 @end defmac
9037
9038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9039 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9040 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9041 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9042 @end deftypefn
9043
9044 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9045 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9046 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9047
9048 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9049 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9050 define the macro.
9051
9052 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9053 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9054 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9055 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9056 @end defmac
9057
9058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9059 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9060 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9061 defined.
9062 @end deftypefn
9063
9064 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9065 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9066 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9067 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9068
9069 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9070 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9071 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9072 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9073 @end defmac
9074
9075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9076 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9077 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9078 is defined.
9079 @end deftypefn
9080
9081 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9082 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9083 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9084 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9085 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9086 @end defmac
9087
9088 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9089 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9090 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9091 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9092 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9093 section.
9094 @end defmac
9095
9096 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9097 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9098 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9099 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9100 @end defmac
9101
9102 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9103 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9104 for padding, if necessary.
9105 @end defmac
9106
9107 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9108 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9109 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9110 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9111 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9112 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9113 @end defmac
9114
9115 @need 3000
9116 @node Debugging Info
9117 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9118
9119 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9120 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9121
9122 @menu
9123 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9124 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9125 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9126 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9127 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9128 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9129 @end menu
9130
9131 @node All Debuggers
9132 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9133
9134 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9135 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9136
9137 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9138 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9139 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9140 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9141 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9142 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9143 compiler and another for DBX@.
9144
9145 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9146 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9147 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9148 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9149 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9150
9151 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9152 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9153 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9154 @end defmac
9155
9156 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9157 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9158 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9159 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9160 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9161 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9162 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9163 @option{-g} options is used.
9164 @end defmac
9165
9166 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9167 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9168 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9169 @var{offset}.
9170 @end defmac
9171
9172 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9173 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9174 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9175 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9176 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9177 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9178 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9179
9180 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9181 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9182 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9183 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9184 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9185
9186 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9187 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9188 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9189 @end defmac
9190
9191 @node DBX Options
9192 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9193
9194 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9195 These are specific options for DBX output.
9196
9197 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9198 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9199 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9200 @end defmac
9201
9202 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9203 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9204 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9205 @end defmac
9206
9207 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9208 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9209 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9210 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9211 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9212 if there is any occasion to.
9213 @end defmac
9214
9215 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9216 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9217 in the text section.
9218 @end defmac
9219
9220 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9221 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9222 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9223 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9224 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9225 @end defmac
9226
9227 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9228 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9229 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9230 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9231 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9232 information format.
9233 @end defmac
9234
9235 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9236 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9237 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9238 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9239 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9240 @end defmac
9241
9242 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9243 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9244 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9245 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9246 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9247 @end defmac
9248
9249 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9250 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9251 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9252 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9253 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9254 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9255 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9256 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9257 @end defmac
9258
9259 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9260 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9261 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9262 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9263 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9264 if backslash is correct for your system.
9265 @end defmac
9266
9267 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9268 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9269 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9270 variable.
9271 @end defmac
9272
9273 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9274 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9275 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9276 @end defmac
9277
9278 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9279 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9280 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9281 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9282 @end defmac
9283
9284 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9285 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9286 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9287 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9288 @end defmac
9289
9290 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9291 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9292 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9293 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9294 @end defmac
9295
9296 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9297 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9298 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9299 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9300 code.
9301 @end defmac
9302
9303 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9304 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9305 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9306 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9307 an absolute address.
9308 @end defmac
9309
9310 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9311 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9312 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9313 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9314 @end defmac
9315
9316 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9317 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9318 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9319 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9320 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9321 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9322 number for a type number.
9323 @end defmac
9324
9325 @node DBX Hooks
9326 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9327
9328 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9329 These are hooks for DBX format.
9330
9331 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9332 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9333 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9334 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9335 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9336 unique labels in the assembly output.
9337
9338 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9339 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9340 @end defmac
9341
9342 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9343 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9344 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9345 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9346 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9347 @end defmac
9348
9349 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9350 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9351 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9352 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9353 @end defmac
9354
9355 @node File Names and DBX
9356 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9357
9358 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9359 This describes file names in DBX format.
9360
9361 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9362 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9363 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9364 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9365 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9366
9367 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9368 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9369
9370 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9371 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9372 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9373 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9374 @end defmac
9375
9376 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9377 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9378 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9379 the beginning of the file.
9380 @end defmac
9381
9382 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9383 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9384 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9385 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9386 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9387 @end defmac
9388
9389 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9390 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9391 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9392 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9393
9394 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9395 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9396 @end defmac
9397
9398 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9399 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9400 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9401 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9402 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9403 @end defmac
9404
9405 @need 2000
9406 @node SDB and DWARF
9407 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9408
9409 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9410 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9411
9412 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9413 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9414 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9415 @end defmac
9416
9417 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9418 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9419 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9420
9421 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9422 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9423 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9424 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9425 @end deftypefn
9426
9427 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9428 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9429 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9430 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9431 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9432 @end defmac
9433
9434 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9435 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9436 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9437 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9438 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9439 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9440 @end defmac
9441
9442 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9443 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9444 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9445 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9446 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9447
9448 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9449 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9450
9451 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9452 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9453 @end deftypefn
9454
9455 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9456 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9457 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9458 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9459 @end defmac
9460
9461 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9462 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9463 @end deftypevr
9464
9465 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9466 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9467 @end deftypevr
9468
9469 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9470 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9471 @end deftypevr
9472
9473 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9474 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9475 @end deftypevr
9476
9477 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9478 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9479 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9480 @end defmac
9481
9482 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9483 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9484 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9485 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9486 @end defmac
9487
9488 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9489 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9490 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9491 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9492 @end defmac
9493
9494 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9495 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9496 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9497 @end defmac
9498
9499 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9500 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9501 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9502 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9503 is referenced by a function.
9504 @end defmac
9505
9506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9507 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9508 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9509 @end deftypefn
9510
9511 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9512 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9513 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9514 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9515 not define them yourself.
9516 @end defmac
9517
9518 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9519 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9520 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9521 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9522 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9523 required.
9524 @end defmac
9525
9526 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9527 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9528 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9529 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9530 it.
9531 @end defmac
9532
9533 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9534 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9535 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9536 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9537 @end defmac
9538
9539 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9540 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9541 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9542 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9543 @end defmac
9544
9545 @need 2000
9546 @node VMS Debug
9547 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9548
9549 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9550 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9551
9552 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9553 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9554 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9555 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9556 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9557 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9558 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9559 @end defmac
9560
9561 @node Floating Point
9562 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9563 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9564 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9565
9566 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9567 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9568 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9569 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9570 doing the compilation.
9571
9572 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9573 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9574 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9575 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9576 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9577 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9578 target floating point formats are identical.
9579
9580 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9581 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9582 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9583 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9584
9585 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9586 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9587 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9588 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9589 quantity.
9590 @end defmac
9591
9592 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9593 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9594 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9595 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9596 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9597 @end deftypefn
9598
9599 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9600 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9601 @end deftypefn
9602
9603 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9604 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9605 @end deftypefn
9606
9607 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9608 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9609 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9610 @end deftypefn
9611
9612 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9613 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9614 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9615 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9616 defined by the C language for both.
9617 @end deftypefn
9618
9619 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9620 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9621 @end deftypefn
9622
9623 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9624 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9625 @end deftypefn
9626
9627 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9628 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9629 @end deftypefn
9630
9631 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9632 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9633 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9634 variable).
9635
9636 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9637 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9638 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9639
9640 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9641 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9642 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9643 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9644 @end deftypefn
9645
9646 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9647 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9648 @end deftypefn
9649
9650 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9651 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9652 @end deftypefn
9653
9654 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9655 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9656 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9657 integral, it is truncated.
9658 @end deftypefn
9659
9660 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9661 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9662 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9663 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9664 @end deftypefn
9665
9666 @node Mode Switching
9667 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9668 @cindex mode switching
9669 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9670
9671 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9672 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9673 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9674
9675 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9676 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9677 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9678 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9679 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9680 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9681 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9682
9683 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9684 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9685 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9686 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9687 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9688 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9689 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9690 are optional.
9691 @end defmac
9692
9693 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9694 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9695 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9696 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9697 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9698 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9699 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9700 entity in question.
9701 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9702 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9703 switch is needed / supplied.
9704 @end defmac
9705
9706 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9707 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9708 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9709 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9710 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9711 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9712 @end defmac
9713
9714 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9715 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9716 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9717 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9718 different from the incoming mode).
9719 @end defmac
9720
9721 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9722 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9723 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9724 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9725 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9726 @end defmac
9727
9728 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9729 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9730 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9731 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9732 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9733 @end defmac
9734
9735 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9736 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9737 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9738 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9739 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9740 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9741 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9742 @end defmac
9743
9744 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9745 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9746 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9747 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9748 @end defmac
9749
9750 @node Target Attributes
9751 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9752 @cindex target attributes
9753 @cindex machine attributes
9754 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9755
9756 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9757 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9758 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9759
9760 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9761 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9762 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9763 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9764 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9765 take.
9766 @end deftypevr
9767
9768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9769 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9770 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9771 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9772 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9773 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9774 @end deftypefn
9775
9776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9777 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9778 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9779 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9780 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9781 supposed always to be compatible.
9782 @end deftypefn
9783
9784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9785 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9786 the newly defined @var{type}.
9787 @end deftypefn
9788
9789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9790 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9791 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9792 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9793 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9794 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9795 merging.
9796 @end deftypefn
9797
9798 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9799 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9800 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9801 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9802 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9803 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9804 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9805 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9806
9807 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9808 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9809 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9810 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9811 will then define a function called
9812 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9813 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9814 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9815 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9816 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9817 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9818 @end deftypefn
9819
9820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9821 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9822 @end deftypefn
9823
9824 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9825 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9826 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9827 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9828 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9829 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9830 on this implementation detail.
9831 @end defmac
9832
9833 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9834 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9835 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9836 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9837 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9838 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9839 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9840 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9841 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9842 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9843 needed.
9844 @end deftypefn
9845
9846 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9847 @cindex inlining
9848 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
9849 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9850 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9851 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9852 @end deftypefn
9853
9854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9855 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9856 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9857 These function-specific options may differ
9858 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9859 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9860
9861 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9862 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9863 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9864 @end deftypefn
9865
9866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9867 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9868 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
9869 options.
9870 @xref{Option file format}.
9871 @end deftypefn
9872
9873 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9874 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9875 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9876 function-specific options.
9877 @end deftypefn
9878
9879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9880 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
9881 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9882 function-specific options.
9883 @end deftypefn
9884
9885 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9886 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
9887 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
9888 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
9889 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9890 @end deftypefn
9891
9892 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9893 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9894 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9895 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9896 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9897
9898 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9899 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9900
9901 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9902 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9903 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9904 @end deftypefn
9905
9906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9907 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9908 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9909 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9910 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9911 different target machines.
9912 @end deftypefn
9913
9914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9915 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9916 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9917 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9918 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9919 @end deftypefn
9920
9921 @node Emulated TLS
9922 @section Emulating TLS
9923 @cindex Emulated TLS
9924
9925 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9926 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9927 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9928 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9929 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9930 layer.
9931
9932 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9933 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9934 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9935 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9936
9937 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9938 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9939 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9940 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9941 @end deftypevr
9942
9943 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9944 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9945 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9946 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9947 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9948 registration function to be used.
9949 @end deftypevr
9950
9951 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9952 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9953 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9954 any section.
9955 @end deftypevr
9956
9957 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9958 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9959 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9960 section.
9961 @end deftypevr
9962
9963 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9964 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9965 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9966 @end deftypevr
9967
9968 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9969 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9970 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9971 @end deftypevr
9972
9973 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9974 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9975 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9976 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9977 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9978 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9979 @end deftypefn
9980
9981 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9982 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9983 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9984 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9985 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9986 @end deftypefn
9987
9988 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9989 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9990 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9991 single objects. The default is false.
9992 @end deftypevr
9993
9994 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9995 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9996 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9997 @end deftypevr
9998
9999 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10000 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10001 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10002
10003 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10004 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10005 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10006 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10007
10008 @smallexample
10009 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10010 unsigned int d;
10011
10012 d = cp0count + 3;
10013 @end smallexample
10014
10015 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10016 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10017 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10018
10019 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10020 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10021 later in the function.
10022
10023 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10024 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10025 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10026
10027 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10028 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10029
10030 @node PCH Target
10031 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10032 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10033
10034 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10035 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10036 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10037 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10038 @end deftypefn
10039
10040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10041 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10042 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10043 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10044 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10045
10046 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10047 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10048 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10049 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10050
10051 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10052 suitable for most targets.
10053 @end deftypefn
10054
10055 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10056 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10057 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10058 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10059 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10060 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10061 @end deftypefn
10062
10063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10064 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10065 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10066 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10067 to do anything here.
10068 @end deftypefn
10069
10070 @node C++ ABI
10071 @section C++ ABI parameters
10072 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10073
10074 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10075 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10076 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10077 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10078 @end deftypefn
10079
10080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10081 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10082 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10083 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10084 @end deftypefn
10085
10086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10087 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10088 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10089 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10090 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10091 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10092 @end deftypefn
10093
10094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10095 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10096 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10097 @end deftypefn
10098
10099 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10100 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10101 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10102 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10103 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10104 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10105 backend's targeted operating system.
10106 @end deftypefn
10107
10108 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10109 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10110 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10111 @code{false}.
10112 @end deftypefn
10113
10114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10115 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10116 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10117 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10118 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10119 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10120 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10121 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10122 @end deftypefn
10123
10124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10125 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10126 @end deftypefn
10127
10128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10129 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10130 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10131 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10132 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10133 unit will not be COMDAT.
10134 @end deftypefn
10135
10136 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10137 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10138 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10139 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10140 @end deftypefn
10141
10142 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10143 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10144 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10145 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10146 @end deftypefn
10147
10148 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10149 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10150 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10151 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10152 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10153 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10154 @end deftypefn
10155
10156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10157 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10158 @end deftypefn
10159
10160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10161 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10162 @end deftypefn
10163
10164 @node Named Address Spaces
10165 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10166 @cindex named address spaces
10167
10168 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10169 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10170 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10171 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10172 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10173 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10174 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10175 @code{const} type attributes.
10176
10177 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10178 pointers to the generic address space.
10179
10180 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10181 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10182 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10183 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10184 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10185 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10186 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10187 always 32 bits).
10188
10189 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10190 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10191 address space.
10192
10193 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10194 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10195 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10196 named address space #1:
10197 @smallexample
10198 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10199 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10200 @end smallexample
10201
10202 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10203 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10204 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10205 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10206 generic address space only.
10207 @end deftypefn
10208
10209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10210 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10211 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10212 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10213 generic address space only.
10214 @end deftypefn
10215
10216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10217 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10218 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10219 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10220 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10221 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10222 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10223 target hooks for the given address space.
10224 @end deftypefn
10225
10226 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10227 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10228 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10229 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10230 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10231 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10232 explicit named address space support.
10233 @end deftypefn
10234
10235 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10236 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10237 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10238 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10239 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10240 @end deftypefn
10241
10242 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10243 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10244 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10245 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10246 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10247 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10248 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10249 @end deftypefn
10250
10251 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10252 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10253 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10254 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10255 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10256 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10257 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10258 @end deftypefn
10259
10260 @node Misc
10261 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10262 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10263
10264 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10265 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10266
10267 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10268 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10269 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10270 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10271 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10272 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10273 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10274 @end defmac
10275
10276 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10277 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10278 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10279 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10280 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10281 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10282 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10283 @end defmac
10284
10285 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10286 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10287 elements of a jump-table should have.
10288 @end defmac
10289
10290 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10291 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10292 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10293 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10294 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10295 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10296 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10297 flags can be updated.
10298 @end defmac
10299
10300 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10301 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10302 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10303 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10304 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10305 is in effect.
10306 @end defmac
10307
10308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10309 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10310 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10311 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10312 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10313 @end deftypefn
10314
10315 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10316 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10317 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10318 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10319 @end defmac
10320
10321 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10322 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10323 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10324 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10325 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10326 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10327 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10328 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10329
10330 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10331 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10332 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10333 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10334 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10335
10336 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10337 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10338 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10339 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10340 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10341
10342 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10343 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10344 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10345 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10346 @end defmac
10347
10348 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10349 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10350 extends.
10351 @end defmac
10352
10353 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10354 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10355 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10356 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10357 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10358 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10359 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10360 @end deftypefn
10361
10362 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10363 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10364 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10365 @end defmac
10366
10367 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10368 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10369 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10370 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10371 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10372 at run-time.
10373 @end defmac
10374
10375 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10376 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10377 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10378 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10379 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10380 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10381 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10382 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10383 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10384 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10385 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10386
10387 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10388 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10389 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10390
10391 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10392 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10393 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10394 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10395 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10396
10397 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10398 @end defmac
10399
10400 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10401 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10402 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10403 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10404 @xref{shift patterns}.
10405
10406 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10407 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10408 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10409 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10410 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10411 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10412
10413 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10414 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10415 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10416
10417 The default implementation of this function returns
10418 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10419 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10420 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10421 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10422 by overriding it.
10423 @end deftypefn
10424
10425 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10426 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10427 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10428 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10429 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10430
10431 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10432
10433 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10434 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10435 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10436 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10437 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10438 such cases may improve things.
10439 @end defmac
10440
10441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10442 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10443 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10444 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10445 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10446 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10447 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10448 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10449 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10450 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10451 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10452
10453 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10454 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10455 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10456 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10457
10458 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10459 describe two related properties. If you define
10460 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10461 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10462 extension.
10463
10464 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10465 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10466 @code{mode}.
10467 @end deftypefn
10468
10469 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10470 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10471 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10472 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10473 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10474 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10475
10476 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10477 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10478 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10479 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10480 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10481 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10482 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10483 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10484 the compiler.
10485
10486 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10487 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10488 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10489 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10490 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10491 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10492 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10493 expression
10494
10495 @smallexample
10496 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10497 @end smallexample
10498
10499 @noindent
10500 can be converted to
10501
10502 @smallexample
10503 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10504 @end smallexample
10505
10506 @noindent
10507 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10508 tested into the sign bit.
10509
10510 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10511 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10512 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10513 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10514 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10515 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10516
10517 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10518 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10519 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10520 to be used:
10521
10522 @itemize @bullet
10523 @item
10524 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10525 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10526 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10527 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10528 combine the normalization with other operations.
10529
10530 @item
10531 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10532 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10533 other machines.
10534
10535 @item
10536 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10537 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10538 others.
10539
10540 @item
10541 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10542 @end itemize
10543
10544 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10545 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10546 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10547 those cases, e.g., one matching
10548
10549 @smallexample
10550 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10551 @end smallexample
10552
10553 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10554 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10555 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10556 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10557 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10558 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10559 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10560 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10561
10562 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10563 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10564 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10565 @end defmac
10566
10567 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10568 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10569 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10570 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10571 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10572 this macro.
10573 @end defmac
10574
10575 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10576 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10577 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10578 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10579 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10580 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10581 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10582 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10583 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10584 given mode.
10585 @end defmac
10586
10587 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10588 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10589 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10590 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10591 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10592 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10593 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10594 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10595 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10596 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10597 this value.
10598
10599 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10600 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10601
10602 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10603 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10604 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10605 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10606
10607 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10608 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10609 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10610 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10611 breaking the API@.
10612 @end defmac
10613
10614 @defmac Pmode
10615 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10616 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10617 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10618 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10619 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10620
10621 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10622 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10623 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10624 to @code{Pmode}.
10625 @end defmac
10626
10627 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10628 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10629 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10630 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10631 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10632 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10633 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10634 @end defmac
10635
10636 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10637 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10638 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10639 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10640 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10641 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10642
10643 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10644 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10645 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10646 @end defmac
10647
10648 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10649 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10650
10651 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10652 @end deftypefn
10653
10654 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10655 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10656 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10657 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10658 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10659 @end defmac
10660
10661 @findex #pragma
10662 @findex pragma
10663 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10664 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10665 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10666 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10667 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10668 setup required for the pragmas.
10669
10670 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10671 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10672 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10673
10674 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10675 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10676
10677 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10678 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10679 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10680 @end defmac
10681
10682 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10683 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10684
10685 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10686 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10687 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10688 pragma of the form
10689
10690 @smallexample
10691 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10692 @end smallexample
10693
10694 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10695 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10696 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10697 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10698 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10699 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10700 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10701 arguments of pragmas registered with
10702 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10703 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10704
10705 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10706 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10707 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10708 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10709 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10710 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10711 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10712 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10713 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10714 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10715 how to build this object file.
10716 @end deftypefun
10717
10718 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10719 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10720 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10721 @end defmac
10722
10723 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10724 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10725 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10726 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10727 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10728 @end defmac
10729
10730 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10731 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10732 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10733 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10734 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10735 @end defmac
10736
10737 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10738 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10739 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10740 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10741 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10742 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10743 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10744 you should define this macro.
10745
10746 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10747 @end defmac
10748
10749 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10750 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10751 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10752 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10753 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10754 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10755 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10756 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10757 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10758 slot of @var{insn}.
10759
10760 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10761 @end defmac
10762
10763 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10764 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10765 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10766 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10767 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10768 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10769
10770 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10771 @end defmac
10772
10773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10774 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10775 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10776 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10777 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10778 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10779 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10780 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10781 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10782 @end deftypefn
10783
10784 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10785 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10786 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10787 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10788 separate math library.
10789
10790 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10791 @end defmac
10792
10793 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10794 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10795 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10796
10797 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10798 is wrong.
10799 @end defmac
10800
10801 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10802 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10803 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10804 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10805 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10806 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10807 for cross-profiling.
10808 @end defmac
10809
10810 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10811
10812 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10813 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10814 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10815 1 if it does use cc0.
10816 @end defmac
10817
10818 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10819 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10820 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10821 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10822 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10823 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10824 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10825 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10826 @end defmac
10827
10828 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10829 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10830 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10831 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10832 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10833 @end defmac
10834
10835 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10836 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10837 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10838 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10839 about the currently processed blocks.
10840 @end defmac
10841
10842 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10843 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10844 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10845 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10846 to by @var{ce_info}.
10847 @end defmac
10848
10849 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10850 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10851 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10852 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10853 to by @var{ce_info}.
10854 @end defmac
10855
10856 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10857 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10858 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10859 to by @var{ce_info}.
10860 @end defmac
10861
10862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10863 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10864 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10865 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10866
10867 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10868 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10869 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10870 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10871
10872 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10873 definition is null.
10874 @end deftypefn
10875
10876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10877 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10878 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10879 necessary setup.
10880
10881 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10882 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10883 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10884 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10885
10886 To create a built-in function, call the function
10887 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10888 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10889 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10890 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10891 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10892 @end deftypefn
10893
10894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10895 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10896 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10897 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10898 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10899 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10900 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10901 @code{error_mark_node}.
10902 @end deftypefn
10903
10904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10905
10906 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10907 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10908 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10909 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10910 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10911 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10912 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10913 built-in function.
10914 @end deftypefn
10915
10916 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10917 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10918 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10919 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10920 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10921 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10922 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10923 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10924 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10925 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10926 @end deftypefn
10927
10928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10929 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10930 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10931 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10932 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10933 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
10934 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
10935 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10936 @end deftypefn
10937
10938 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
10939 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
10940 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
10941 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
10942 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
10943 @end deftypefn
10944
10945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10946 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
10947 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
10948 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
10949 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
10950 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
10951 the two function decls that will be compared.
10952 @end deftypefn
10953
10954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
10955 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
10956 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
10957 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
10958 identical versions.
10959 @end deftypefn
10960
10961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
10962 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
10963 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
10964 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
10965 body must be generated.
10966 @end deftypefn
10967
10968 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10969
10970 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10971 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10972 could not be applied.
10973
10974 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10975 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10976 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10977 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10978 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10979 @end deftypefn
10980
10981 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
10982 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10983 @end deftypefn
10984
10985 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10986
10987 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10988 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10989 @var{branch2} is possible.
10990
10991 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10992 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10993 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10994 @end defmac
10995
10996 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
10997 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
10998 @end deftypefn
10999
11000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11001 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11002 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11003 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11004 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11005 @end deftypefn
11006
11007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11008
11009 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11010 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11011 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11012 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11013 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11014 that had its initial value copied by using
11015 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11016 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11017 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11018 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11019 @code{MEM}.
11020 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11021 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11022 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11023 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11024 register in question will not be clobbered.
11025 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11026 allocation.
11027 @end deftypefn
11028
11029 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11030 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11031 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11032 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11033 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11034 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11035 passed along.
11036 @end deftypefn
11037
11038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11039 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11040 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11041 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11042 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11043 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11044 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11045 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11046 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11047 The default hook function does nothing.
11048
11049 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11050 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11051 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11052 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11053 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11054 outside of any function scope.
11055 @end deftypefn
11056
11057 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11058 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11059 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11060 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11061 @end defmac
11062
11063 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11064 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11065 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11066 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11067 executable files.
11068 @end defmac
11069
11070 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11071 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11072 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11073 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11074 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11075 lists.
11076 @end defmac
11077
11078 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11079 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11080 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11081 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11082 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11083 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11084 defined as this expression:
11085
11086 @smallexample
11087 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11088 build_tree_list
11089 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11090 NULL))
11091 @end smallexample
11092 @end defmac
11093
11094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11095 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11096 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11097 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11098 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11099
11100 @smallexample
11101 static bool
11102 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11103 @{
11104 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11105 @}
11106 @end smallexample
11107 @end deftypefn
11108
11109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11110 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11111 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11112 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11113 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11114 to inter-block scheduling.
11115 @end deftypefn
11116
11117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11118 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11119 registers
11120 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11121 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11122 that all target registers in the class returned by
11123 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11124 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11125 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11126 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11127 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11128 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11129 @end deftypefn
11130
11131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11132 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11133 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11134 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11135 @end deftypefn
11136
11137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11138 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11139 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11140 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11141 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11142 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11143 number of memory accesses.
11144 @end deftypefn
11145
11146 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11147 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11148 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11149 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11150 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11151 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11152 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11153 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11154 @end defmac
11155
11156 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11157 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11158 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11159 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11160 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11161 @end deftypefn
11162
11163 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11164 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11165 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11166 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11167 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11168 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11169 @end deftypefn
11170
11171 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11172 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11173 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11174 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11175 that are different from @option{-I}.
11176 @end deftypefn
11177
11178 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11179 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11180 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11181 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11182 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11183 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11184 @end defmac
11185
11186 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11187 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11188 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11189 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11190 @end defmac
11191
11192 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11193 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11194 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11195 @end defmac
11196
11197 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11198 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11199 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11200 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11201 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11202 @end defmac
11203
11204 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11205 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11206 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11207 @end defmac
11208
11209 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11210 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11211 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11212 and scanf formatter settings.
11213 @end defmac
11214
11215 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11216 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11217 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11218 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11219 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11220 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11221 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11222 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11223 @end deftypevr
11224
11225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11226 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11227 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11228 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11229 @end deftypefn
11230
11231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11232 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11233 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11234 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11235 @end deftypefn
11236
11237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11238 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11239 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11240 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11241 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11242 @end deftypefn
11243
11244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11245 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11246 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11247 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11248 the front end.
11249 @end deftypefn
11250
11251 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11252 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11253 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11254 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11255 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11256 @end deftypefn
11257
11258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11259 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11260 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11261 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11262 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11263 @end deftypefn
11264
11265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11266 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11267 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11268 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11269 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11270 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11271 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11272 @end deftypefn
11273
11274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11275 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11276 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11277 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11278 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11279 conversion rules.
11280 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11281 @end deftypefn
11282
11283 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11284 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11285 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11286 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11287 @end defmac
11288
11289 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11290 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11291 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11292 @end defmac
11293
11294 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11295 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11296 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11297 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11298 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11299 @end defmac
11300
11301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11302 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11303 necessary.
11304 @end deftypefn
11305
11306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11307 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11308 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11309 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11310 is needed.
11311 @end deftypefn
11312
11313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11314 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11315 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11316 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11317 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11318 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11319 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11320 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11321 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11322 @end deftypefn
11323
11324 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11325 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11326 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11327 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11328 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11329 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11330 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11331 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11332 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11333 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11334 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11335 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11336 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11337 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11338 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11339 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11340 @end deftypevr
11341
11342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11343 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11344 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11345 supported by the target.
11346 @end deftypefn
11347
11348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11349 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11350 memory model bits are allowed.
11351 @end deftypefn
11352
11353 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11354 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11355 @end deftypevr
11356
11357 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11358 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11359 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11360 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11361 @end deftypefn